1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H 3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H 4 /* 5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface 6 * 7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2021 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #include <linux/ethtool.h> 14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h> 15 #include <linux/netdevice.h> 16 #include <linux/debugfs.h> 17 #include <linux/list.h> 18 #include <linux/bug.h> 19 #include <linux/netlink.h> 20 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 21 #include <linux/nl80211.h> 22 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 24 #include <linux/net.h> 25 #include <linux/rfkill.h> 26 #include <net/regulatory.h> 27 28 /** 29 * DOC: Introduction 30 * 31 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges 32 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated 33 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used 34 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent 35 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers 36 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely. 37 * 38 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum 39 * use restrictions. 40 */ 41 42 43 /** 44 * DOC: Device registration 45 * 46 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device 47 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs 48 * described below. 49 * 50 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each 51 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each 52 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with 53 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's 54 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes 55 * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the 56 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating 57 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the 58 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful. 59 * 60 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has 61 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and 62 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail. 63 */ 64 65 struct wiphy; 66 67 /* 68 * wireless hardware capability structures 69 */ 70 71 /** 72 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags 73 * 74 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code. 75 * 76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled. 77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes 78 * sending probe requests or beaconing. 79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel. 80 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel 81 * is not permitted. 82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel 83 * is not permitted. 84 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel. 85 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band, 86 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this 87 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 88 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 89 * restrictions. 90 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band, 91 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this 92 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 93 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 94 * restrictions. 95 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY 96 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 97 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 98 * on this channel. 99 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 100 * on this channel. 101 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel. 102 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted 103 * on this channel. 104 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted 105 * on this channel. 106 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted 107 * on this channel. 108 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted 109 * on this channel. 110 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted 111 * on this channel. 112 * 113 */ 114 enum ieee80211_channel_flags { 115 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = 1<<0, 116 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = 1<<1, 117 /* hole at 1<<2 */ 118 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = 1<<3, 119 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<4, 120 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<5, 121 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = 1<<6, 122 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = 1<<7, 123 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = 1<<8, 124 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = 1<<9, 125 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<10, 126 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = 1<<11, 127 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = 1<<12, 128 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = 1<<13, 129 IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = 1<<14, 130 IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = 1<<15, 131 IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = 1<<16, 132 IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = 1<<17, 133 IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = 1<<18, 134 }; 135 136 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \ 137 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS) 138 139 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000 140 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000) 141 142 /** 143 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition 144 * 145 * This structure describes a single channel for use 146 * with cfg80211. 147 * 148 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz 149 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz 150 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel 151 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags. 152 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory 153 * code to support devices with additional restrictions 154 * @band: band this channel belongs to. 155 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi 156 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm) 157 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm) 158 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon 159 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon() 160 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band. 161 * @orig_mag: internal use 162 * @orig_mpwr: internal use 163 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required 164 * on this channel. 165 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 166 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels. 167 */ 168 struct ieee80211_channel { 169 enum nl80211_band band; 170 u32 center_freq; 171 u16 freq_offset; 172 u16 hw_value; 173 u32 flags; 174 int max_antenna_gain; 175 int max_power; 176 int max_reg_power; 177 bool beacon_found; 178 u32 orig_flags; 179 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr; 180 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state; 181 unsigned long dfs_state_entered; 182 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms; 183 }; 184 185 /** 186 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags 187 * 188 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured 189 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for 190 * different bands/PHY modes. 191 * 192 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short 193 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and 194 * with CCK rates. 195 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 196 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the 197 * core code when registering the wiphy. 198 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 199 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 200 * core code when registering the wiphy. 201 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 202 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 203 * core code when registering the wiphy. 204 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode. 205 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode 206 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode 207 */ 208 enum ieee80211_rate_flags { 209 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<0, 210 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = 1<<1, 211 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = 1<<2, 212 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = 1<<3, 213 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = 1<<4, 214 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = 1<<5, 215 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = 1<<6, 216 }; 217 218 /** 219 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter 220 * 221 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS 222 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS 223 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS 224 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS 225 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type 226 */ 227 enum ieee80211_bss_type { 228 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS, 229 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS, 230 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 231 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS, 232 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY 233 }; 234 235 /** 236 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter 237 * 238 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set 239 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear 240 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting 241 */ 242 enum ieee80211_privacy { 243 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON, 244 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF, 245 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY 246 }; 247 248 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \ 249 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF) 250 251 /** 252 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition 253 * 254 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can 255 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short 256 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are 257 * passed around. 258 * 259 * @flags: rate-specific flags 260 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps 261 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate 262 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when 263 * short preamble is used 264 */ 265 struct ieee80211_rate { 266 u32 flags; 267 u16 bitrate; 268 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short; 269 }; 270 271 /** 272 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse 273 * 274 * @enable: is the feature enabled. 275 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element. 276 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset 277 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use 278 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use 279 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by 280 * members of the SRG 281 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values 282 * used by members of the SRG 283 */ 284 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd { 285 bool enable; 286 u8 sr_ctrl; 287 u8 non_srg_max_offset; 288 u8 min_offset; 289 u8 max_offset; 290 u8 bss_color_bitmap[8]; 291 u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8]; 292 }; 293 294 /** 295 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring 296 * 297 * @color: the current color. 298 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used 299 * @partial: define the AID equation. 300 */ 301 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color { 302 u8 color; 303 bool enabled; 304 bool partial; 305 }; 306 307 /** 308 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities 309 * 310 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 311 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA. 312 * 313 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA 314 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec 315 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor 316 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing 317 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates 318 */ 319 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap { 320 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */ 321 bool ht_supported; 322 u8 ampdu_factor; 323 u8 ampdu_density; 324 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs; 325 }; 326 327 /** 328 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities 329 * 330 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 331 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA. 332 * 333 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA 334 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec 335 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates 336 */ 337 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap { 338 bool vht_supported; 339 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */ 340 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs; 341 }; 342 343 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25 344 345 /** 346 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities 347 * 348 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 349 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA. 350 * 351 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid. 352 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element. 353 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. 354 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. 355 */ 356 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap { 357 bool has_he; 358 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem; 359 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp; 360 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; 361 }; 362 363 /** 364 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type 365 * 366 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the 367 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the 368 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data. 369 * 370 * @types_mask: interface types mask 371 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities 372 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a 373 * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value). 374 * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise 375 * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data 376 * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length 377 */ 378 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data { 379 u16 types_mask; 380 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 381 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 382 struct { 383 const u8 *data; 384 unsigned int len; 385 } vendor_elems; 386 }; 387 388 /** 389 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations 390 * 391 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz 392 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz 393 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz 394 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz 395 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 396 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 397 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 398 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and 399 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 400 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 401 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 402 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 403 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 404 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 405 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 406 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz, 407 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 408 */ 409 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config { 410 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4, 411 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5, 412 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6, 413 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7, 414 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8, 415 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9, 416 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10, 417 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11, 418 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12, 419 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13, 420 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14, 421 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15, 422 }; 423 424 /** 425 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration 426 * 427 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 428 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration 429 * 430 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s) 431 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions. 432 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc. 433 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported. 434 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 435 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations 436 */ 437 struct ieee80211_edmg { 438 u8 channels; 439 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config; 440 }; 441 442 /** 443 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities 444 * 445 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 446 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA. 447 * 448 * @s1g_supported: is STA an S1G STA 449 * @cap: S1G capabilities information 450 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set 451 */ 452 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap { 453 bool s1g; 454 u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */ 455 u8 nss_mcs[5]; 456 }; 457 458 /** 459 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition 460 * 461 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy 462 * is able to operate in. 463 * 464 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with 465 * in this band. 466 * @band: the band this structure represents 467 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels 468 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with 469 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported 470 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM. 471 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates 472 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band 473 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band 474 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band 475 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band 476 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course) 477 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries 478 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in 479 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only 480 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of 481 * iftype_data). 482 */ 483 struct ieee80211_supported_band { 484 struct ieee80211_channel *channels; 485 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates; 486 enum nl80211_band band; 487 int n_channels; 488 int n_bitrates; 489 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 490 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 491 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap; 492 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap; 493 u16 n_iftype_data; 494 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data; 495 }; 496 497 /** 498 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype 499 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 500 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 501 * 502 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found 503 */ 504 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * 505 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 506 u8 iftype) 507 { 508 int i; 509 510 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX)) 511 return NULL; 512 513 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++) { 514 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 515 &sband->iftype_data[i]; 516 517 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype)) 518 return data; 519 } 520 521 return NULL; 522 } 523 524 /** 525 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype 526 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 527 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 528 * 529 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found 530 */ 531 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 532 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 533 u8 iftype) 534 { 535 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 536 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 537 538 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he) 539 return &data->he_cap; 540 541 return NULL; 542 } 543 544 /** 545 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 546 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 547 * @iftype: the iftype to search for 548 * 549 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 550 */ 551 static inline __le16 552 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 553 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 554 { 555 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 556 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 557 558 if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he)) 559 return 0; 560 561 return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa; 562 } 563 564 /** 565 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree 566 * 567 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for 568 * 569 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful 570 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board 571 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier). 572 * 573 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable 574 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with 575 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make 576 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified 577 * without affecting other devices. 578 * 579 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev. 580 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first. 581 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register(). 582 */ 583 #ifdef CONFIG_OF 584 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy); 585 #else /* CONFIG_OF */ 586 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy) 587 { 588 } 589 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */ 590 591 592 /* 593 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods 594 */ 595 596 /** 597 * DOC: Actions and configuration 598 * 599 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration 600 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these 601 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these 602 * operations use are described separately. 603 * 604 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status 605 * information via some functions that drivers need to call. 606 * 607 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described 608 * in a separate chapter. 609 */ 610 611 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\ 612 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN) 613 614 /** 615 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters 616 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise 617 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set 618 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames 619 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface. 620 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may 621 * determine the address as needed. 622 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the 623 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating 624 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC. 625 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets 626 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed 627 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring 628 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed 629 */ 630 struct vif_params { 631 u32 flags; 632 int use_4addr; 633 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN]; 634 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups; 635 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr; 636 }; 637 638 /** 639 * struct key_params - key information 640 * 641 * Information about a key 642 * 643 * @key: key material 644 * @key_len: length of key material 645 * @cipher: cipher suite selector 646 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used 647 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian, 648 * length given by @seq_len. 649 * @seq_len: length of @seq. 650 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero) 651 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX) 652 */ 653 struct key_params { 654 const u8 *key; 655 const u8 *seq; 656 int key_len; 657 int seq_len; 658 u16 vlan_id; 659 u32 cipher; 660 enum nl80211_key_mode mode; 661 }; 662 663 /** 664 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition 665 * @chan: the (control) channel 666 * @width: channel width 667 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment 668 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment 669 * (only with 80+80 MHz) 670 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration. 671 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero), 672 * chan will define the primary channel and all other 673 * parameters are ignored. 674 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz 675 */ 676 struct cfg80211_chan_def { 677 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 678 enum nl80211_chan_width width; 679 u32 center_freq1; 680 u32 center_freq2; 681 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 682 u16 freq1_offset; 683 }; 684 685 /* 686 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control 687 */ 688 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask { 689 struct { 690 u32 legacy; 691 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN]; 692 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; 693 u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; 694 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi; 695 enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi; 696 enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf; 697 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 698 }; 699 700 701 /** 702 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration 703 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration 704 * of the peer. 705 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify 706 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed, 707 * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp. 708 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID 709 * @retry_long: retry count value 710 * @retry_short: retry count value 711 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation 712 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS 713 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation 714 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type 715 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID 716 */ 717 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg { 718 bool config_override; 719 u8 tids; 720 u64 mask; 721 enum nl80211_tid_config noack; 722 u8 retry_long, retry_short; 723 enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu; 724 enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts; 725 enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu; 726 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type; 727 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask; 728 }; 729 730 /** 731 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration 732 * @peer: Station's MAC address 733 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied 734 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info 735 */ 736 struct cfg80211_tid_config { 737 const u8 *peer; 738 u32 n_tid_conf; 739 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[]; 740 }; 741 742 /** 743 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef 744 * @chandef: the channel definition 745 * 746 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given 747 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion. 748 */ 749 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type 750 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 751 { 752 switch (chandef->width) { 753 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 754 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 755 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 756 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20; 757 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 758 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq) 759 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS; 760 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS; 761 default: 762 WARN_ON(1); 763 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 764 } 765 } 766 767 /** 768 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type 769 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill 770 * @channel: the control channel 771 * @chantype: the channel type 772 * 773 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition. 774 */ 775 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 776 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 777 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype); 778 779 /** 780 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical 781 * @chandef1: first channel definition 782 * @chandef2: second channel definition 783 * 784 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are 785 * identical, %false otherwise. 786 */ 787 static inline bool 788 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 789 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2) 790 { 791 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan && 792 chandef1->width == chandef2->width && 793 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 && 794 chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset && 795 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2); 796 } 797 798 /** 799 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel 800 * 801 * @chandef: the channel definition 802 * 803 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise. 804 */ 805 static inline bool 806 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 807 { 808 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config; 809 } 810 811 /** 812 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible 813 * @chandef1: first channel definition 814 * @chandef2: second channel definition 815 * 816 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible, 817 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise. 818 */ 819 const struct cfg80211_chan_def * 820 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 821 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2); 822 823 /** 824 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid 825 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 826 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise. 827 */ 828 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 829 830 /** 831 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used 832 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 833 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 834 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set 835 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise. 836 */ 837 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, 838 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 839 u32 prohibited_flags); 840 841 /** 842 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required 843 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 844 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 845 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype 846 * Returns: 847 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error 848 */ 849 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy, 850 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 851 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 852 853 /** 854 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel 855 * 856 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK 857 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels. 858 * 859 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 860 * 861 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel 862 */ 863 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags 864 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 865 { 866 switch (chandef->width) { 867 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 868 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ; 869 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 870 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ; 871 default: 872 break; 873 } 874 return 0; 875 } 876 877 /** 878 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef 879 * 880 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel 881 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual 882 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels. 883 * 884 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 885 * 886 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef 887 */ 888 static inline int 889 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 890 { 891 switch (chandef->width) { 892 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 893 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6, 894 chandef->chan->max_power); 895 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 896 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3, 897 chandef->chan->max_power); 898 default: 899 break; 900 } 901 return chandef->chan->max_power; 902 } 903 904 /** 905 * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels 906 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for 907 * @band_mask: which bands to check on 908 * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable, 909 * %IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account 910 */ 911 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy, 912 unsigned long band_mask, 913 u32 prohibited_flags); 914 915 /** 916 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags 917 * 918 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in 919 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used 920 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in 921 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in 922 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in 923 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in 924 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in 925 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in 926 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in 927 * 928 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info 929 * it has filled in during the get_survey(). 930 */ 931 enum survey_info_flags { 932 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0), 933 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1), 934 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2), 935 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3), 936 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4), 937 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5), 938 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6), 939 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7), 940 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8), 941 }; 942 943 /** 944 * struct survey_info - channel survey response 945 * 946 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single 947 * record to report global statistics 948 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags 949 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are 950 * optional 951 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel) 952 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy 953 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy 954 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data 955 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data 956 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning 957 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS 958 * 959 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information. 960 * 961 * This structure can later be expanded with things like 962 * channel duty cycle etc. 963 */ 964 struct survey_info { 965 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 966 u64 time; 967 u64 time_busy; 968 u64 time_ext_busy; 969 u64 time_rx; 970 u64 time_tx; 971 u64 time_scan; 972 u64 time_bss_rx; 973 u32 filled; 974 s8 noise; 975 }; 976 977 #define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS 4 978 979 /** 980 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings 981 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled 982 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions) 983 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset) 984 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers 985 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites 986 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites 987 * @akm_suites: AKM suites 988 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 989 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 990 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 991 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 992 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be 993 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports 994 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port 995 * protocol frames. 996 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 997 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 998 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control 999 * port for mac80211 1000 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 1001 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 1002 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 1003 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload) 1004 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE 1005 * offload) 1006 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload) 1007 * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation: 1008 * 1009 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED 1010 * Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any 1011 * preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in 1012 * such a scenario. 1013 * 1014 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK 1015 * Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only 1016 * 1017 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT 1018 * Allow hash-to-element only 1019 * 1020 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH 1021 * Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element 1022 */ 1023 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings { 1024 u32 wpa_versions; 1025 u32 cipher_group; 1026 int n_ciphers_pairwise; 1027 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES]; 1028 int n_akm_suites; 1029 u32 akm_suites[NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES]; 1030 bool control_port; 1031 __be16 control_port_ethertype; 1032 bool control_port_no_encrypt; 1033 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 1034 bool control_port_no_preauth; 1035 struct key_params *wep_keys; 1036 int wep_tx_key; 1037 const u8 *psk; 1038 const u8 *sae_pwd; 1039 u8 sae_pwd_len; 1040 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe; 1041 }; 1042 1043 /** 1044 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data 1045 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE) 1046 * or %NULL if not changed 1047 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE) 1048 * or %NULL if not changed 1049 * @head_len: length of @head 1050 * @tail_len: length of @tail 1051 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL 1052 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets 1053 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response 1054 * frames or %NULL 1055 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets 1056 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association 1057 * Response frames or %NULL 1058 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets 1059 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp) 1060 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only) 1061 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change 1062 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data) 1063 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token 1064 * (measurement type 8) 1065 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement 1066 * Token (measurement type 11) 1067 * @lci_len: LCI data length 1068 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length 1069 */ 1070 struct cfg80211_beacon_data { 1071 const u8 *head, *tail; 1072 const u8 *beacon_ies; 1073 const u8 *proberesp_ies; 1074 const u8 *assocresp_ies; 1075 const u8 *probe_resp; 1076 const u8 *lci; 1077 const u8 *civicloc; 1078 s8 ftm_responder; 1079 1080 size_t head_len, tail_len; 1081 size_t beacon_ies_len; 1082 size_t proberesp_ies_len; 1083 size_t assocresp_ies_len; 1084 size_t probe_resp_len; 1085 size_t lci_len; 1086 size_t civicloc_len; 1087 }; 1088 1089 struct mac_address { 1090 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 1091 }; 1092 1093 /** 1094 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data 1095 * 1096 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's 1097 * entry specified by mac_addr 1098 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed 1099 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL 1100 */ 1101 struct cfg80211_acl_data { 1102 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy; 1103 int n_acl_entries; 1104 1105 /* Keep it last */ 1106 struct mac_address mac_addrs[]; 1107 }; 1108 1109 /** 1110 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 1111 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 1112 * 1113 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1114 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1115 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1116 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action 1117 * frame headers. 1118 */ 1119 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery { 1120 u32 min_interval; 1121 u32 max_interval; 1122 size_t tmpl_len; 1123 const u8 *tmpl; 1124 }; 1125 1126 /** 1127 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe 1128 * response parameters in 6GHz. 1129 * 1130 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned 1131 * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive 1132 * scanning 1133 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1134 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response 1135 */ 1136 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp { 1137 u32 interval; 1138 size_t tmpl_len; 1139 const u8 *tmpl; 1140 }; 1141 1142 /** 1143 * enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags 1144 * 1145 * Used by cfg80211_ap_settings 1146 * 1147 * @AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external authentication 1148 */ 1149 enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags { 1150 AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(0), 1151 }; 1152 1153 /** 1154 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration 1155 * 1156 * Used to configure an AP interface. 1157 * 1158 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 1159 * @beacon: beacon data 1160 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1161 * @dtim_period: DTIM period 1162 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from 1163 * user space) 1164 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid 1165 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames 1166 * @crypto: crypto settings 1167 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy 1168 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 1169 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode 1170 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity. 1171 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window 1172 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS 1173 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for 1174 * MAC address based access control 1175 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG 1176 * networks. 1177 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 1178 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled) 1179 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled) 1180 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1181 * @ht_required: stations must support HT 1182 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT 1183 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time 1184 * @he_required: stations must support HE 1185 * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE 1186 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags 1187 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings 1188 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings 1189 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1190 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters 1191 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters 1192 */ 1193 struct cfg80211_ap_settings { 1194 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1195 1196 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; 1197 1198 int beacon_interval, dtim_period; 1199 const u8 *ssid; 1200 size_t ssid_len; 1201 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid; 1202 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 1203 bool privacy; 1204 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 1205 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1206 int inactivity_timeout; 1207 u8 p2p_ctwindow; 1208 bool p2p_opp_ps; 1209 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl; 1210 bool pbss; 1211 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 1212 1213 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap; 1214 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap; 1215 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap; 1216 const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper; 1217 bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required; 1218 bool twt_responder; 1219 u32 flags; 1220 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 1221 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 1222 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 1223 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; 1224 }; 1225 1226 /** 1227 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings 1228 * 1229 * Used for channel switch 1230 * 1231 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch 1232 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch 1233 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) 1234 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response 1235 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail) 1236 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response 1237 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel 1238 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel 1239 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing 1240 * @count: number of beacons until switch 1241 */ 1242 struct cfg80211_csa_settings { 1243 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1244 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa; 1245 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon; 1246 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp; 1247 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon; 1248 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp; 1249 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after; 1250 bool radar_required; 1251 bool block_tx; 1252 u8 count; 1253 }; 1254 1255 /** 1256 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations 1257 * 1258 * Used to pass interface combination parameters 1259 * 1260 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want 1261 * to use for verification 1262 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel 1263 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of 1264 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths 1265 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface 1266 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum 1267 * nl80211_iftype. 1268 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface 1269 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of 1270 * the verification 1271 */ 1272 struct iface_combination_params { 1273 int num_different_channels; 1274 u8 radar_detect; 1275 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES]; 1276 u32 new_beacon_int; 1277 }; 1278 1279 /** 1280 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply 1281 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp) 1282 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability 1283 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state 1284 * 1285 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling, 1286 * for those that don't these flags will are used. 1287 */ 1288 enum station_parameters_apply_mask { 1289 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0), 1290 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1), 1291 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2), 1292 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER = BIT(3), 1293 }; 1294 1295 /** 1296 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 1297 * 1298 * Used to configure txpower for station. 1299 * 1300 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power 1301 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be 1302 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx 1303 * power per-interface or per-station. 1304 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 1305 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 1306 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 1307 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 1308 * per peer TPC. 1309 */ 1310 struct sta_txpwr { 1311 s16 power; 1312 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 1313 }; 1314 1315 /** 1316 * struct station_parameters - station parameters 1317 * 1318 * Used to change and create a new station. 1319 * 1320 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to 1321 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1322 * (or NULL for no change) 1323 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates 1324 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed 1325 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1326 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values 1327 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1328 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change 1329 * @aid: AID or zero for no change 1330 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero) 1331 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change 1332 * @plink_action: plink action to take 1333 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station 1334 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station 1335 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station 1336 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format 1337 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 1338 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the 1339 * QoS info field (but already shifted down) 1340 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed 1341 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value), 1342 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask 1343 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set 1344 * to unknown) 1345 * @capability: station capability 1346 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station 1347 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities 1348 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format 1349 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels 1350 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format 1351 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes 1352 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification 1353 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used 1354 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism 1355 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station 1356 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities 1357 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station 1358 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station 1359 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station 1360 */ 1361 struct station_parameters { 1362 const u8 *supported_rates; 1363 struct net_device *vlan; 1364 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set; 1365 u32 sta_modify_mask; 1366 int listen_interval; 1367 u16 aid; 1368 u16 vlan_id; 1369 u16 peer_aid; 1370 u8 supported_rates_len; 1371 u8 plink_action; 1372 u8 plink_state; 1373 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa; 1374 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa; 1375 u8 uapsd_queues; 1376 u8 max_sp; 1377 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1378 u16 capability; 1379 const u8 *ext_capab; 1380 u8 ext_capab_len; 1381 const u8 *supported_channels; 1382 u8 supported_channels_len; 1383 const u8 *supported_oper_classes; 1384 u8 supported_oper_classes_len; 1385 u8 opmode_notif; 1386 bool opmode_notif_used; 1387 int support_p2p_ps; 1388 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa; 1389 u8 he_capa_len; 1390 u16 airtime_weight; 1391 struct sta_txpwr txpwr; 1392 const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa; 1393 }; 1394 1395 /** 1396 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters 1397 * 1398 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations). 1399 * 1400 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations 1401 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal 1402 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication) 1403 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame 1404 */ 1405 struct station_del_parameters { 1406 const u8 *mac; 1407 u8 subtype; 1408 u16 reason_code; 1409 }; 1410 1411 /** 1412 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified 1413 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface 1414 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still 1415 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted) 1416 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has 1417 * the AP MLME in the device 1418 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface 1419 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station 1420 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry 1421 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when 1422 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is 1423 * supported/used) 1424 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active 1425 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace) 1426 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed) 1427 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed) 1428 */ 1429 enum cfg80211_station_type { 1430 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT, 1431 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC, 1432 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT, 1433 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA, 1434 CFG80211_STA_IBSS, 1435 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP, 1436 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE, 1437 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL, 1438 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER, 1439 }; 1440 1441 /** 1442 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes 1443 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on 1444 * @params: the new parameters for a station 1445 * @statype: the type of station being modified 1446 * 1447 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function 1448 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that 1449 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if 1450 * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for 1451 * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this. 1452 */ 1453 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1454 struct station_parameters *params, 1455 enum cfg80211_station_type statype); 1456 1457 /** 1458 * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags 1459 * 1460 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1461 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1462 * 1463 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS 1464 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS 1465 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval 1466 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS 1467 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information 1468 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode 1469 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS 1470 */ 1471 enum rate_info_flags { 1472 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0), 1473 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1), 1474 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1475 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3), 1476 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4), 1477 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5), 1478 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG = BIT(6), 1479 }; 1480 1481 /** 1482 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information 1483 * 1484 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth. 1485 * 1486 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth 1487 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth 1488 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth 1489 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth 1490 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth 1491 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth 1492 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation 1493 */ 1494 enum rate_info_bw { 1495 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0, 1496 RATE_INFO_BW_5, 1497 RATE_INFO_BW_10, 1498 RATE_INFO_BW_40, 1499 RATE_INFO_BW_80, 1500 RATE_INFO_BW_160, 1501 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU, 1502 }; 1503 1504 /** 1505 * struct rate_info - bitrate information 1506 * 1507 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate 1508 * 1509 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags 1510 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate 1511 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg 1512 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only) 1513 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw) 1514 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi) 1515 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1516 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc, 1517 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU) 1518 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4) 1519 */ 1520 struct rate_info { 1521 u8 flags; 1522 u8 mcs; 1523 u16 legacy; 1524 u8 nss; 1525 u8 bw; 1526 u8 he_gi; 1527 u8 he_dcm; 1528 u8 he_ru_alloc; 1529 u8 n_bonded_ch; 1530 }; 1531 1532 /** 1533 * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags 1534 * 1535 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1536 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1537 * 1538 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled 1539 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 1540 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled 1541 */ 1542 enum bss_param_flags { 1543 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = 1<<0, 1544 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<1, 1545 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = 1<<2, 1546 }; 1547 1548 /** 1549 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station 1550 * 1551 * Information about the currently associated BSS 1552 * 1553 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags 1554 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS 1555 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1556 */ 1557 struct sta_bss_parameters { 1558 u8 flags; 1559 u8 dtim_period; 1560 u16 beacon_interval; 1561 }; 1562 1563 /** 1564 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID 1565 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to 1566 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1567 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged 1568 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged 1569 * @flows: number of new flows seen 1570 * @drops: total number of packets dropped 1571 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE 1572 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow 1573 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow 1574 * @collisions: number of hash collisions 1575 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued 1576 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued 1577 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported 1578 */ 1579 struct cfg80211_txq_stats { 1580 u32 filled; 1581 u32 backlog_bytes; 1582 u32 backlog_packets; 1583 u32 flows; 1584 u32 drops; 1585 u32 ecn_marks; 1586 u32 overlimit; 1587 u32 overmemory; 1588 u32 collisions; 1589 u32 tx_bytes; 1590 u32 tx_packets; 1591 u32 max_flows; 1592 }; 1593 1594 /** 1595 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics 1596 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to 1597 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1598 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs 1599 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs 1600 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for 1601 * transmitted MSDUs 1602 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs 1603 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics 1604 */ 1605 struct cfg80211_tid_stats { 1606 u32 filled; 1607 u64 rx_msdu; 1608 u64 tx_msdu; 1609 u64 tx_msdu_retries; 1610 u64 tx_msdu_failed; 1611 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats; 1612 }; 1613 1614 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4 1615 1616 /** 1617 * struct station_info - station information 1618 * 1619 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station. 1620 * 1621 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to 1622 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 1623 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected 1624 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds 1625 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association 1626 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station 1627 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station 1628 * @llid: mesh local link id 1629 * @plid: mesh peer link id 1630 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state 1631 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1632 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1633 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1634 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1635 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg 1636 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm 1637 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm 1638 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station 1639 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station 1640 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station 1641 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station 1642 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs) 1643 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK) 1644 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason. 1645 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters 1646 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 1647 * This number should increase every time the list of stations 1648 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 1649 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 1650 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request. 1651 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use 1652 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for 1653 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. 1654 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets. 1655 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values 1656 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered. 1657 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host. 1658 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode 1659 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode 1660 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode 1661 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers) 1662 * towards this station. 1663 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer 1664 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received 1665 * from this peer 1666 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate 1667 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer 1668 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer 1669 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight 1670 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last 1671 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs. 1672 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL. 1673 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame. 1674 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has 1675 * been sent. 1676 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station 1677 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with 1678 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the 1679 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address. 1680 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric. 1681 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server 1682 */ 1683 struct station_info { 1684 u64 filled; 1685 u32 connected_time; 1686 u32 inactive_time; 1687 u64 assoc_at; 1688 u64 rx_bytes; 1689 u64 tx_bytes; 1690 u16 llid; 1691 u16 plid; 1692 u8 plink_state; 1693 s8 signal; 1694 s8 signal_avg; 1695 1696 u8 chains; 1697 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1698 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1699 1700 struct rate_info txrate; 1701 struct rate_info rxrate; 1702 u32 rx_packets; 1703 u32 tx_packets; 1704 u32 tx_retries; 1705 u32 tx_failed; 1706 u32 rx_dropped_misc; 1707 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param; 1708 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags; 1709 1710 int generation; 1711 1712 const u8 *assoc_req_ies; 1713 size_t assoc_req_ies_len; 1714 1715 u32 beacon_loss_count; 1716 s64 t_offset; 1717 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1718 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm; 1719 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm; 1720 1721 u32 expected_throughput; 1722 1723 u64 tx_duration; 1724 u64 rx_duration; 1725 u64 rx_beacon; 1726 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg; 1727 u8 connected_to_gate; 1728 1729 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid; 1730 s8 ack_signal; 1731 s8 avg_ack_signal; 1732 1733 u16 airtime_weight; 1734 1735 u32 rx_mpdu_count; 1736 u32 fcs_err_count; 1737 1738 u32 airtime_link_metric; 1739 1740 u8 connected_to_as; 1741 }; 1742 1743 /** 1744 * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit 1745 * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm 1746 * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to 1747 */ 1748 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs { 1749 s32 power; 1750 u32 freq_range_index; 1751 }; 1752 1753 /** 1754 * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs 1755 * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types 1756 * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs 1757 * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs 1758 */ 1759 struct cfg80211_sar_specs { 1760 enum nl80211_sar_type type; 1761 u32 num_sub_specs; 1762 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[]; 1763 }; 1764 1765 1766 /** 1767 * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges 1768 * @start_freq: start range edge frequency 1769 * @end_freq: end range edge frequency 1770 */ 1771 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges { 1772 u32 start_freq; 1773 u32 end_freq; 1774 }; 1775 1776 /** 1777 * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability 1778 * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types 1779 * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges 1780 * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges. 1781 * 1782 * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing 1783 * range to small ones and then append them. 1784 */ 1785 struct cfg80211_sar_capa { 1786 enum nl80211_sar_type type; 1787 u32 num_freq_ranges; 1788 const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges; 1789 }; 1790 1791 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) 1792 /** 1793 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station 1794 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to 1795 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest 1796 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information 1797 * 1798 * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information 1799 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be 1800 * considered undefined. 1801 */ 1802 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 1803 struct station_info *sinfo); 1804 #else 1805 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, 1806 const u8 *mac_addr, 1807 struct station_info *sinfo) 1808 { 1809 return -ENOENT; 1810 } 1811 #endif 1812 1813 /** 1814 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags 1815 * 1816 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits 1817 * according to the nl80211 flags. 1818 * 1819 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed 1820 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS 1821 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP 1822 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames 1823 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering 1824 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing 1825 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address 1826 */ 1827 enum monitor_flags { 1828 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, 1829 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, 1830 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, 1831 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, 1832 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, 1833 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, 1834 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, 1835 }; 1836 1837 /** 1838 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags 1839 * 1840 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled 1841 * in during get_station() or dump_station(). 1842 * 1843 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled 1844 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled 1845 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled 1846 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled 1847 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled 1848 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled 1849 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled 1850 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled 1851 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled 1852 */ 1853 enum mpath_info_flags { 1854 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0), 1855 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1), 1856 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2), 1857 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3), 1858 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4), 1859 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5), 1860 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6), 1861 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7), 1862 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8), 1863 }; 1864 1865 /** 1866 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information 1867 * 1868 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath(). 1869 * 1870 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags 1871 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination 1872 * @sn: target sequence number 1873 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path 1874 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs 1875 * @flags: mesh path flags 1876 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs 1877 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries 1878 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 1879 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths 1880 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 1881 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 1882 * @hop_count: hops to destination 1883 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination 1884 */ 1885 struct mpath_info { 1886 u32 filled; 1887 u32 frame_qlen; 1888 u32 sn; 1889 u32 metric; 1890 u32 exptime; 1891 u32 discovery_timeout; 1892 u8 discovery_retries; 1893 u8 flags; 1894 u8 hop_count; 1895 u32 path_change_count; 1896 1897 int generation; 1898 }; 1899 1900 /** 1901 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters 1902 * 1903 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode). 1904 * 1905 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection 1906 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1907 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed 1908 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1909 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed 1910 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1911 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1912 * (or NULL for no change) 1913 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates 1914 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations 1915 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1916 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode 1917 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change) 1918 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change) 1919 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change) 1920 */ 1921 struct bss_parameters { 1922 int use_cts_prot; 1923 int use_short_preamble; 1924 int use_short_slot_time; 1925 const u8 *basic_rates; 1926 u8 basic_rates_len; 1927 int ap_isolate; 1928 int ht_opmode; 1929 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps; 1930 }; 1931 1932 /** 1933 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration 1934 * 1935 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active. 1936 * 1937 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used 1938 * by the Mesh Peering Open message 1939 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units 1940 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message 1941 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by 1942 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering 1943 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this 1944 * mesh interface 1945 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can 1946 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh 1947 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA 1948 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection 1949 * elements 1950 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we 1951 * detect compatible mesh peers 1952 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to 1953 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method 1954 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ 1955 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target 1956 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds 1957 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on 1958 * a path discovery in milliseconds 1959 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 1960 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the 1961 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit) 1962 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 1963 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ 1964 * element 1965 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 1966 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR 1967 * element 1968 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that 1969 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh 1970 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA 1971 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root 1972 * announcements are transmitted 1973 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh 1974 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is 1975 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true 1976 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but 1977 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the 1978 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec) 1979 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding 1980 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) 1981 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate 1982 * station to establish a peer link 1983 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode 1984 * 1985 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 1986 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to 1987 * the root mesh STA to be valid. 1988 * 1989 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive 1990 * PREQs are transmitted. 1991 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs) 1992 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing 1993 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation. 1994 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial 1995 * setting for new peer links. 1996 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake 1997 * after transmitting its beacon. 1998 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established 1999 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it 2000 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes. 2001 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is 2002 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the 2003 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths 2004 * in the mesh path table 2005 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP 2006 * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might 2007 * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So 2008 * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable 2009 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. 2010 */ 2011 struct mesh_config { 2012 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout; 2013 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout; 2014 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout; 2015 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks; 2016 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries; 2017 u8 dot11MeshTTL; 2018 u8 element_ttl; 2019 bool auto_open_plinks; 2020 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor; 2021 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries; 2022 u32 path_refresh_time; 2023 u16 min_discovery_timeout; 2024 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout; 2025 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval; 2026 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval; 2027 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime; 2028 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode; 2029 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate; 2030 bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer; 2031 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval; 2032 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol; 2033 bool dot11MeshForwarding; 2034 s32 rssi_threshold; 2035 u16 ht_opmode; 2036 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout; 2037 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval; 2038 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval; 2039 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode; 2040 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration; 2041 u32 plink_timeout; 2042 bool dot11MeshNolearn; 2043 }; 2044 2045 /** 2046 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration 2047 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2048 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID 2049 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes 2050 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use 2051 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use 2052 * @path_metric: which metric to use 2053 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using 2054 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional) 2055 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements 2056 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication 2057 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security 2058 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions 2059 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use 2060 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2061 * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a] 2062 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh 2063 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 2064 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2065 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2066 * to operate on DFS channels. 2067 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2068 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2069 * 2070 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created. 2071 */ 2072 struct mesh_setup { 2073 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2074 const u8 *mesh_id; 2075 u8 mesh_id_len; 2076 u8 sync_method; 2077 u8 path_sel_proto; 2078 u8 path_metric; 2079 u8 auth_id; 2080 const u8 *ie; 2081 u8 ie_len; 2082 bool is_authenticated; 2083 bool is_secure; 2084 bool user_mpm; 2085 u8 dtim_period; 2086 u16 beacon_interval; 2087 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2088 u32 basic_rates; 2089 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 2090 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2091 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2092 }; 2093 2094 /** 2095 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration 2096 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2097 * 2098 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network 2099 */ 2100 struct ocb_setup { 2101 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2102 }; 2103 2104 /** 2105 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters 2106 * @ac: AC identifier 2107 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 2108 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2109 * 1..32767] 2110 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2111 * 1..32767] 2112 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] 2113 */ 2114 struct ieee80211_txq_params { 2115 enum nl80211_ac ac; 2116 u16 txop; 2117 u16 cwmin; 2118 u16 cwmax; 2119 u8 aifs; 2120 }; 2121 2122 /** 2123 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling 2124 * 2125 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite 2126 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will 2127 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the 2128 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the 2129 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to 2130 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements 2131 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be 2132 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised 2133 * in the wiphy structure. 2134 * 2135 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because 2136 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not 2137 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist. 2138 * 2139 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of 2140 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the 2141 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available 2142 * to userspace. 2143 */ 2144 2145 /** 2146 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description 2147 * @ssid: the SSID 2148 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid 2149 */ 2150 struct cfg80211_ssid { 2151 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 2152 u8 ssid_len; 2153 }; 2154 2155 /** 2156 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan 2157 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the 2158 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this 2159 * information is not available, this field is left zero. 2160 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set. 2161 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason, 2162 * userspace will be notified of that 2163 */ 2164 struct cfg80211_scan_info { 2165 u64 scan_start_tsf; 2166 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2167 bool aborted; 2168 }; 2169 2170 /** 2171 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only 2172 * 2173 * @short_bssid: short ssid to scan for 2174 * @bssid: bssid to scan for 2175 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request 2176 * which the above info relvant to 2177 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU 2178 * @short_ssid_valid: short_ssid is valid and can be used 2179 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait 2180 * 20 TUs before starting to send probe requests. 2181 */ 2182 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params { 2183 u32 short_ssid; 2184 u32 channel_idx; 2185 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2186 bool unsolicited_probe; 2187 bool short_ssid_valid; 2188 bool psc_no_listen; 2189 }; 2190 2191 /** 2192 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description 2193 * 2194 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only) 2195 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2196 * @channels: channels to scan on. 2197 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2198 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning 2199 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2200 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2201 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If 2202 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and 2203 * the actual dwell time may be shorter. 2204 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the 2205 * %duration field. 2206 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation 2207 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band 2208 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2209 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started 2210 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for 2211 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan 2212 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted 2213 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band 2214 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2215 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2216 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2217 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2218 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only, 2219 * true if this is the second scan request 2220 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params 2221 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params 2222 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID) 2223 */ 2224 struct cfg80211_scan_request { 2225 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2226 int n_ssids; 2227 u32 n_channels; 2228 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2229 const u8 *ie; 2230 size_t ie_len; 2231 u16 duration; 2232 bool duration_mandatory; 2233 u32 flags; 2234 2235 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2236 2237 struct wireless_dev *wdev; 2238 2239 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2240 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2241 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2242 2243 /* internal */ 2244 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2245 unsigned long scan_start; 2246 struct cfg80211_scan_info info; 2247 bool notified; 2248 bool no_cck; 2249 bool scan_6ghz; 2250 u32 n_6ghz_params; 2251 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params; 2252 2253 /* keep last */ 2254 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2255 }; 2256 2257 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask) 2258 { 2259 int i; 2260 2261 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN); 2262 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) { 2263 buf[i] &= ~mask[i]; 2264 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i]; 2265 } 2266 } 2267 2268 /** 2269 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match 2270 * 2271 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match 2272 * or no match (RSSI only) 2273 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match 2274 * or no match (RSSI only) 2275 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm) 2276 * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied 2277 * for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support 2278 * of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability 2279 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band 2280 * specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified. 2281 * If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of 2282 * corresponding matchset. 2283 */ 2284 struct cfg80211_match_set { 2285 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 2286 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2287 s32 rssi_thold; 2288 s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2289 }; 2290 2291 /** 2292 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan 2293 * 2294 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds. 2295 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means 2296 * infinite loop. 2297 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero, 2298 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations. 2299 */ 2300 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan { 2301 u32 interval; 2302 u32 iterations; 2303 }; 2304 2305 /** 2306 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment. 2307 * 2308 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment. 2309 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment. 2310 */ 2311 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust { 2312 enum nl80211_band band; 2313 s8 delta; 2314 }; 2315 2316 /** 2317 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description 2318 * 2319 * @reqid: identifies this request. 2320 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans) 2321 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2322 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2323 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning 2324 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2325 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2326 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation 2327 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result 2328 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host 2329 * (others are filtered out). 2330 * If ommited, all results are passed. 2331 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets 2332 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request 2333 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2334 * @dev: the interface 2335 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan 2336 * @channels: channels to scan 2337 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this 2338 * contains the minimum over all matchsets 2339 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2340 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2341 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2342 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2343 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest 2344 * index must be executed first. 2345 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1. 2346 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct 2347 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request 2348 * owned by a particular socket) 2349 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed 2350 * @list: for keeping list of requests. 2351 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan 2352 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start 2353 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not 2354 * supported. 2355 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not. 2356 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result 2357 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined 2358 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS. 2359 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state. 2360 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong 2361 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported 2362 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that 2363 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative 2364 * comparisions. 2365 */ 2366 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request { 2367 u64 reqid; 2368 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2369 int n_ssids; 2370 u32 n_channels; 2371 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2372 const u8 *ie; 2373 size_t ie_len; 2374 u32 flags; 2375 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets; 2376 int n_match_sets; 2377 s32 min_rssi_thold; 2378 u32 delay; 2379 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans; 2380 int n_scan_plans; 2381 2382 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2383 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2384 2385 bool relative_rssi_set; 2386 s8 relative_rssi; 2387 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust; 2388 2389 /* internal */ 2390 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2391 struct net_device *dev; 2392 unsigned long scan_start; 2393 bool report_results; 2394 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2395 u32 owner_nlportid; 2396 bool nl_owner_dead; 2397 struct list_head list; 2398 2399 /* keep last */ 2400 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2401 }; 2402 2403 /** 2404 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type 2405 * 2406 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available 2407 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm) 2408 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100 2409 */ 2410 enum cfg80211_signal_type { 2411 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE, 2412 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, 2413 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC, 2414 }; 2415 2416 /** 2417 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data 2418 * @chan: channel the frame was received on 2419 * @scan_width: scan width that was used 2420 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's 2421 * signal type 2422 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was 2423 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually 2424 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was 2425 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms. 2426 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of 2427 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate. 2428 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the 2429 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified 2430 * by %parent_bssid. 2431 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to 2432 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received. 2433 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2434 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2435 */ 2436 struct cfg80211_inform_bss { 2437 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 2438 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2439 s32 signal; 2440 u64 boottime_ns; 2441 u64 parent_tsf; 2442 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2443 u8 chains; 2444 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2445 }; 2446 2447 /** 2448 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data 2449 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs 2450 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing 2451 * @len: length of the IEs 2452 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon 2453 * @data: IE data 2454 */ 2455 struct cfg80211_bss_ies { 2456 u64 tsf; 2457 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2458 int len; 2459 bool from_beacon; 2460 u8 data[]; 2461 }; 2462 2463 /** 2464 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description 2465 * 2466 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network) 2467 * for use in scan results and similar. 2468 * 2469 * @channel: channel this BSS is on 2470 * @scan_width: width of the control channel 2471 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS 2472 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame 2473 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order 2474 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these 2475 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or 2476 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been 2477 * received. It is always non-%NULL. 2478 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame 2479 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't 2480 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the 2481 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct) 2482 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame 2483 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from 2484 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct 2485 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and 2486 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case. 2487 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a 2488 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support) 2489 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one 2490 * (multi-BSSID support) 2491 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type) 2492 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2493 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2494 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set 2495 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set 2496 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes 2497 */ 2498 struct cfg80211_bss { 2499 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2500 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2501 2502 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies; 2503 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies; 2504 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies; 2505 2506 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss; 2507 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss; 2508 struct list_head nontrans_list; 2509 2510 s32 signal; 2511 2512 u16 beacon_interval; 2513 u16 capability; 2514 2515 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2516 u8 chains; 2517 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2518 2519 u8 bssid_index; 2520 u8 max_bssid_indicator; 2521 2522 u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2523 }; 2524 2525 /** 2526 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID 2527 * @bss: the bss to search 2528 * @id: the element ID 2529 * 2530 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2531 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2532 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2533 */ 2534 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id); 2535 2536 /** 2537 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID 2538 * @bss: the bss to search 2539 * @id: the element ID 2540 * 2541 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2542 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2543 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2544 */ 2545 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id) 2546 { 2547 return (void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id); 2548 } 2549 2550 2551 /** 2552 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data 2553 * 2554 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2555 * authentication. 2556 * 2557 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference 2558 * to it if it needs to keep it. 2559 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2560 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL 2561 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2562 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2563 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2564 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2565 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains 2566 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the 2567 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication 2568 * transaction sequence number field. 2569 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets 2570 */ 2571 struct cfg80211_auth_request { 2572 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2573 const u8 *ie; 2574 size_t ie_len; 2575 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2576 const u8 *key; 2577 u8 key_len, key_idx; 2578 const u8 *auth_data; 2579 size_t auth_data_len; 2580 }; 2581 2582 /** 2583 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association. 2584 * 2585 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n) 2586 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT 2587 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association 2588 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external 2589 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to 2590 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect() 2591 * request (connect callback). 2592 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE: Disable HE 2593 */ 2594 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags { 2595 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0), 2596 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1), 2597 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2), 2598 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3), 2599 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE = BIT(4), 2600 }; 2601 2602 /** 2603 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data 2604 * 2605 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2606 * (re)association. 2607 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is 2608 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc() 2609 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new 2610 * association requests while already associating must be rejected. 2611 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL 2612 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2613 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association 2614 * @crypto: crypto settings 2615 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 2616 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 2617 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 2618 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 2619 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 2620 * frame. 2621 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 2622 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2623 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2624 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2625 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override 2626 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use 2627 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or 2628 * %NULL if FILS is not used. 2629 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets 2630 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association 2631 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts 2632 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. 2633 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override 2634 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask 2635 */ 2636 struct cfg80211_assoc_request { 2637 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2638 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid; 2639 size_t ie_len; 2640 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 2641 bool use_mfp; 2642 u32 flags; 2643 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2644 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2645 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask; 2646 const u8 *fils_kek; 2647 size_t fils_kek_len; 2648 const u8 *fils_nonces; 2649 struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask; 2650 }; 2651 2652 /** 2653 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data 2654 * 2655 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2656 * deauthentication. 2657 * 2658 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS to deauthenticate from 2659 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL 2660 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2661 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication 2662 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and 2663 * do not set a deauth frame 2664 */ 2665 struct cfg80211_deauth_request { 2666 const u8 *bssid; 2667 const u8 *ie; 2668 size_t ie_len; 2669 u16 reason_code; 2670 bool local_state_change; 2671 }; 2672 2673 /** 2674 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data 2675 * 2676 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2677 * disassociation. 2678 * 2679 * @bss: the BSS to disassociate from 2680 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL 2681 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2682 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation 2683 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no 2684 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted. 2685 */ 2686 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request { 2687 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2688 const u8 *ie; 2689 size_t ie_len; 2690 u16 reason_code; 2691 bool local_state_change; 2692 }; 2693 2694 /** 2695 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters 2696 * 2697 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss() 2698 * method. 2699 * 2700 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null. 2701 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero. 2702 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not 2703 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID. 2704 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found 2705 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for 2706 * IBSSs to join on other channels. 2707 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon 2708 * @ie_len: length of that 2709 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2710 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured 2711 * after joining 2712 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 2713 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 2714 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 2715 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 2716 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2717 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2718 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2719 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2720 * to operate on DFS channels. 2721 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS 2722 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 2723 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2724 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2725 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2726 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 2727 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 2728 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 2729 */ 2730 struct cfg80211_ibss_params { 2731 const u8 *ssid; 2732 const u8 *bssid; 2733 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2734 const u8 *ie; 2735 u8 ssid_len, ie_len; 2736 u16 beacon_interval; 2737 u32 basic_rates; 2738 bool channel_fixed; 2739 bool privacy; 2740 bool control_port; 2741 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2742 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2743 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2744 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2745 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2746 struct key_params *wep_keys; 2747 int wep_tx_key; 2748 }; 2749 2750 /** 2751 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection. 2752 * 2753 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour. 2754 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour. 2755 * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF. 2756 * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST. 2757 */ 2758 struct cfg80211_bss_selection { 2759 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour; 2760 union { 2761 enum nl80211_band band_pref; 2762 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust; 2763 } param; 2764 }; 2765 2766 /** 2767 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters 2768 * 2769 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2770 * authentication and association. 2771 * 2772 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based 2773 * on scan results) 2774 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or 2775 * %NULL if not specified 2776 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan 2777 * results) 2778 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or 2779 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is 2780 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS 2781 * to use. 2782 * @ssid: SSID 2783 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets 2784 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2785 * @ie: IEs for association request 2786 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets 2787 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used 2788 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used 2789 * @crypto: crypto settings 2790 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2791 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2792 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2793 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 2794 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds 2795 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used. 2796 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2797 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2798 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2799 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides 2800 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used. 2801 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG 2802 * networks. 2803 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection. 2804 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 2805 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 2806 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 2807 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 2808 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 2809 * frame. 2810 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the 2811 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped 2812 * data IE. 2813 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets. 2814 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or 2815 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and 2816 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 2817 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets. 2818 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP 2819 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 2820 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional 2821 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified. 2822 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets. 2823 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver 2824 * offload of 4-way handshake. 2825 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels. 2826 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver 2827 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration. 2828 */ 2829 struct cfg80211_connect_params { 2830 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2831 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint; 2832 const u8 *bssid; 2833 const u8 *bssid_hint; 2834 const u8 *ssid; 2835 size_t ssid_len; 2836 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2837 const u8 *ie; 2838 size_t ie_len; 2839 bool privacy; 2840 enum nl80211_mfp mfp; 2841 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 2842 const u8 *key; 2843 u8 key_len, key_idx; 2844 u32 flags; 2845 int bg_scan_period; 2846 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2847 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2848 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa; 2849 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask; 2850 bool pbss; 2851 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select; 2852 const u8 *prev_bssid; 2853 const u8 *fils_erp_username; 2854 size_t fils_erp_username_len; 2855 const u8 *fils_erp_realm; 2856 size_t fils_erp_realm_len; 2857 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num; 2858 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk; 2859 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len; 2860 bool want_1x; 2861 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 2862 }; 2863 2864 /** 2865 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated 2866 * 2867 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that 2868 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call. 2869 * 2870 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated 2871 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm, 2872 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated 2873 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated 2874 */ 2875 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed { 2876 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0), 2877 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1), 2878 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2), 2879 }; 2880 2881 /** 2882 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values 2883 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed 2884 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed 2885 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed 2886 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed 2887 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed 2888 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled 2889 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed 2890 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed 2891 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum 2892 */ 2893 enum wiphy_params_flags { 2894 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = 1 << 0, 2895 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = 1 << 1, 2896 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = 1 << 2, 2897 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = 1 << 3, 2898 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = 1 << 4, 2899 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = 1 << 5, 2900 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = 1 << 6, 2901 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = 1 << 7, 2902 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = 1 << 8, 2903 }; 2904 2905 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256 2906 2907 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */ 2908 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000 2909 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000 2910 2911 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */ 2912 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000 2913 2914 /** 2915 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association 2916 * 2917 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA 2918 * caching. 2919 * 2920 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL). 2921 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 2922 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key 2923 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL. 2924 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on 2925 * the hash algorithm used to generate this. 2926 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS 2927 * cache identifier (may be %NULL). 2928 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets. 2929 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the 2930 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be 2931 * %NULL). 2932 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds 2933 * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified. 2934 * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after 2935 * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on 2936 * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK 2937 * used for it expires. 2938 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of 2939 * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified. 2940 * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using 2941 * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this 2942 * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires. 2943 */ 2944 struct cfg80211_pmksa { 2945 const u8 *bssid; 2946 const u8 *pmkid; 2947 const u8 *pmk; 2948 size_t pmk_len; 2949 const u8 *ssid; 2950 size_t ssid_len; 2951 const u8 *cache_id; 2952 u32 pmk_lifetime; 2953 u8 pmk_reauth_threshold; 2954 }; 2955 2956 /** 2957 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern 2958 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes, 2959 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211 2960 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1 2961 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes) 2962 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes) 2963 * 2964 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of 2965 * memory, free @mask only! 2966 */ 2967 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern { 2968 const u8 *mask, *pattern; 2969 int pattern_len; 2970 int pkt_offset; 2971 }; 2972 2973 /** 2974 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters 2975 * 2976 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation 2977 * @src: source IP address 2978 * @dst: destination IP address 2979 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address 2980 * @src_port: source port 2981 * @dst_port: destination port 2982 * @payload_len: data payload length 2983 * @payload: data payload buffer 2984 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration 2985 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets 2986 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length 2987 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data 2988 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask 2989 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer 2990 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration 2991 */ 2992 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp { 2993 struct socket *sock; 2994 __be32 src, dst; 2995 u16 src_port, dst_port; 2996 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN]; 2997 int payload_len; 2998 const u8 *payload; 2999 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq; 3000 u32 data_interval; 3001 u32 wake_len; 3002 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask; 3003 u32 tokens_size; 3004 /* must be last, variable member */ 3005 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok; 3006 }; 3007 3008 /** 3009 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info 3010 * 3011 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device. 3012 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues 3013 * operating as normal during suspend 3014 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected 3015 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet 3016 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern 3017 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 3018 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure 3019 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet 3020 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake 3021 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released 3022 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h. 3023 * NULL if not configured. 3024 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake. 3025 */ 3026 struct cfg80211_wowlan { 3027 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3028 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3029 rfkill_release; 3030 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 3031 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp; 3032 int n_patterns; 3033 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config; 3034 }; 3035 3036 /** 3037 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters 3038 * 3039 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device. 3040 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs. 3041 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence. 3042 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. 3043 * @patterns: array of packet patterns 3044 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 3045 */ 3046 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules { 3047 int delay; 3048 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition; 3049 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 3050 int n_patterns; 3051 }; 3052 3053 /** 3054 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings 3055 * 3056 * This structure defines coalescing settings. 3057 * @rules: array of coalesce rules 3058 * @n_rules: number of rules 3059 */ 3060 struct cfg80211_coalesce { 3061 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules; 3062 int n_rules; 3063 }; 3064 3065 /** 3066 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match 3067 * 3068 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up 3069 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This 3070 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels. 3071 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match 3072 * occurred (in MHz) 3073 */ 3074 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match { 3075 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3076 int n_channels; 3077 u32 channels[]; 3078 }; 3079 3080 /** 3081 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information 3082 * 3083 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in 3084 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide 3085 * match information. 3086 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about 3087 * the matches that triggered the wake up. 3088 */ 3089 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info { 3090 int n_matches; 3091 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[]; 3092 }; 3093 3094 /** 3095 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report 3096 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected 3097 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet 3098 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure 3099 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet 3100 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake 3101 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released 3102 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern 3103 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data 3104 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length 3105 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any. 3106 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data 3107 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for 3108 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which 3109 * it is. 3110 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received 3111 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish 3112 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens 3113 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect 3114 */ 3115 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup { 3116 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3117 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3118 rfkill_release, packet_80211, 3119 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens; 3120 s32 pattern_idx; 3121 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len; 3122 const void *packet; 3123 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect; 3124 }; 3125 3126 /** 3127 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data 3128 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes) 3129 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes) 3130 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes) 3131 * @kek_len: length of kek 3132 * @kck_len length of kck 3133 * @akm: akm (oui, id) 3134 */ 3135 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data { 3136 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr; 3137 u32 akm; 3138 u8 kek_len, kck_len; 3139 }; 3140 3141 /** 3142 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information 3143 * 3144 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE 3145 * 3146 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value 3147 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs 3148 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets 3149 */ 3150 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params { 3151 u16 md; 3152 const u8 *ie; 3153 size_t ie_len; 3154 }; 3155 3156 /** 3157 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters 3158 * 3159 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame 3160 * 3161 * @chan: channel to use 3162 * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required 3163 * @wait: duration for ROC 3164 * @buf: buffer to transmit 3165 * @len: buffer length 3166 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame 3167 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack 3168 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array 3169 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame 3170 */ 3171 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params { 3172 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 3173 bool offchan; 3174 unsigned int wait; 3175 const u8 *buf; 3176 size_t len; 3177 bool no_cck; 3178 bool dont_wait_for_ack; 3179 int n_csa_offsets; 3180 const u16 *csa_offsets; 3181 }; 3182 3183 /** 3184 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception 3185 * 3186 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition 3187 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs 3188 */ 3189 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception { 3190 u8 dscp; 3191 u8 up; 3192 }; 3193 3194 /** 3195 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority 3196 * 3197 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3198 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3199 */ 3200 struct cfg80211_dscp_range { 3201 u8 low; 3202 u8 high; 3203 }; 3204 3205 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */ 3206 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21 3207 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16 3208 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \ 3209 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX) 3210 3211 /** 3212 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information 3213 * 3214 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values 3215 * 3216 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21) 3217 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from 3218 * the user priority DSCP range definition 3219 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority 3220 */ 3221 struct cfg80211_qos_map { 3222 u8 num_des; 3223 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX]; 3224 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8]; 3225 }; 3226 3227 /** 3228 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration 3229 * 3230 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters 3231 * 3232 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255) 3233 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. 3234 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 3235 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 3236 */ 3237 struct cfg80211_nan_conf { 3238 u8 master_pref; 3239 u8 bands; 3240 }; 3241 3242 /** 3243 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN 3244 * configuration 3245 * 3246 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference 3247 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands 3248 */ 3249 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes { 3250 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0), 3251 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1), 3252 }; 3253 3254 /** 3255 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter 3256 * 3257 * @filter: the content of the filter 3258 * @len: the length of the filter 3259 */ 3260 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter { 3261 const u8 *filter; 3262 u8 len; 3263 }; 3264 3265 /** 3266 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function 3267 * 3268 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type 3269 * @service_id: the service ID of the function 3270 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type 3271 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is 3272 * implementation specific. 3273 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted 3274 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active 3275 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up 3276 * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up 3277 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up 3278 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW. 3279 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info 3280 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length 3281 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive 3282 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter 3283 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length 3284 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index 3285 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses 3286 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF 3287 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter 3288 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF. 3289 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters. 3290 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters. 3291 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function. 3292 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier. 3293 */ 3294 struct cfg80211_nan_func { 3295 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 3296 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN]; 3297 u8 publish_type; 3298 bool close_range; 3299 bool publish_bcast; 3300 bool subscribe_active; 3301 u8 followup_id; 3302 u8 followup_reqid; 3303 struct mac_address followup_dest; 3304 u32 ttl; 3305 const u8 *serv_spec_info; 3306 u8 serv_spec_info_len; 3307 bool srf_include; 3308 const u8 *srf_bf; 3309 u8 srf_bf_len; 3310 u8 srf_bf_idx; 3311 struct mac_address *srf_macs; 3312 int srf_num_macs; 3313 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters; 3314 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters; 3315 u8 num_tx_filters; 3316 u8 num_rx_filters; 3317 u8 instance_id; 3318 u64 cookie; 3319 }; 3320 3321 /** 3322 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration 3323 * 3324 * @aa: authenticator address 3325 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes. 3326 * @pmk: the PMK material 3327 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK 3328 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field 3329 * holds PMK-R0. 3330 */ 3331 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf { 3332 const u8 *aa; 3333 u8 pmk_len; 3334 const u8 *pmk; 3335 const u8 *pmk_r0_name; 3336 }; 3337 3338 /** 3339 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication. 3340 * 3341 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces. 3342 * 3343 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant 3344 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space). 3345 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has 3346 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and 3347 * authentication response command interface. 3348 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and 3349 * authentication response command interface. 3350 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the 3351 * authentication request event interface. 3352 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication, 3353 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you 3354 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication 3355 * response command interface (user space to driver). 3356 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 3357 */ 3358 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params { 3359 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action; 3360 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3361 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3362 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite; 3363 u16 status; 3364 const u8 *pmkid; 3365 }; 3366 3367 /** 3368 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics 3369 * 3370 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to 3371 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 3372 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully 3373 * answered 3374 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were 3375 * successfully answered 3376 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions 3377 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions 3378 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions 3379 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication 3380 * of how much time the responder was busy 3381 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from 3382 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with 3383 * the responder 3384 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks 3385 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot 3386 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window 3387 */ 3388 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats { 3389 u32 filled; 3390 u32 success_num; 3391 u32 partial_num; 3392 u32 failed_num; 3393 u32 asap_num; 3394 u32 non_asap_num; 3395 u64 total_duration_ms; 3396 u32 unknown_triggers_num; 3397 u32 reschedule_requests_num; 3398 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num; 3399 }; 3400 3401 /** 3402 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result 3403 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is 3404 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise 3405 * reason than just "failure" 3406 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index 3407 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported 3408 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted 3409 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked 3410 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, 3411 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible 3412 * by the responder 3413 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated 3414 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated 3415 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated 3416 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present) 3417 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present) 3418 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL) 3419 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL) 3420 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3421 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3422 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response 3423 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame 3424 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg) 3425 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is 3426 * the square root of the variance) 3427 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured 3428 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured 3429 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg) 3430 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance) 3431 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread) 3432 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid 3433 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid 3434 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid 3435 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid 3436 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid 3437 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid 3438 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid 3439 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid 3440 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid 3441 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid 3442 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid 3443 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid 3444 */ 3445 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result { 3446 const u8 *lci; 3447 const u8 *civicloc; 3448 unsigned int lci_len; 3449 unsigned int civicloc_len; 3450 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason; 3451 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes; 3452 s16 burst_index; 3453 u8 busy_retry_time; 3454 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3455 u8 burst_duration; 3456 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3457 s32 rssi_avg; 3458 s32 rssi_spread; 3459 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate; 3460 s64 rtt_avg; 3461 s64 rtt_variance; 3462 s64 rtt_spread; 3463 s64 dist_avg; 3464 s64 dist_variance; 3465 s64 dist_spread; 3466 3467 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1, 3468 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1, 3469 rssi_avg_valid:1, 3470 rssi_spread_valid:1, 3471 tx_rate_valid:1, 3472 rx_rate_valid:1, 3473 rtt_avg_valid:1, 3474 rtt_variance_valid:1, 3475 rtt_spread_valid:1, 3476 dist_avg_valid:1, 3477 dist_variance_valid:1, 3478 dist_spread_valid:1; 3479 }; 3480 3481 /** 3482 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result 3483 * @addr: address of the peer 3484 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the 3485 * measurement was made) 3486 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time 3487 * @status: status of the measurement 3488 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not 3489 * reporting partial results always set this flag 3490 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid 3491 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting 3492 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and 3493 * they're all aggregated for userspace. 3494 */ 3495 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result { 3496 u64 host_time, ap_tsf; 3497 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status; 3498 3499 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3500 3501 u8 final:1, 3502 ap_tsf_valid:1; 3503 3504 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type; 3505 3506 union { 3507 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm; 3508 }; 3509 }; 3510 3511 /** 3512 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data 3513 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested 3514 * @preamble: frame preamble to use 3515 * @burst_period: burst period to use 3516 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode 3517 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent 3518 * @burst_duration: burst duration 3519 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst 3520 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request 3521 * @request_lci: request LCI information 3522 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information 3523 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement 3524 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3525 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3526 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement 3527 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3528 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3529 * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either 3530 * @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set. 3531 * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to 3532 * indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if 3533 * @non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set. 3534 * 3535 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation. 3536 */ 3537 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer { 3538 enum nl80211_preamble preamble; 3539 u16 burst_period; 3540 u8 requested:1, 3541 asap:1, 3542 request_lci:1, 3543 request_civicloc:1, 3544 trigger_based:1, 3545 non_trigger_based:1, 3546 lmr_feedback:1; 3547 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3548 u8 burst_duration; 3549 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3550 u8 ftmr_retries; 3551 u8 bss_color; 3552 }; 3553 3554 /** 3555 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request 3556 * @addr: MAC address 3557 * @chandef: channel to use 3558 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF 3559 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer 3560 */ 3561 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer { 3562 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3563 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 3564 u8 report_ap_tsf:1; 3565 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm; 3566 }; 3567 3568 /** 3569 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request 3570 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211 3571 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211 3572 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting, 3573 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211 3574 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request 3575 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that 3576 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 3577 * be taken from the @mac_addr 3578 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request 3579 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if 3580 * zero it means there's no timeout 3581 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with 3582 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data 3583 */ 3584 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request { 3585 u64 cookie; 3586 void *drv_data; 3587 u32 n_peers; 3588 u32 nl_portid; 3589 3590 u32 timeout; 3591 3592 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3593 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3594 3595 struct list_head list; 3596 3597 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[]; 3598 }; 3599 3600 /** 3601 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information 3602 * 3603 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE 3604 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space. 3605 * 3606 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces. 3607 * 3608 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing 3609 * has to be done. 3610 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info 3611 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space 3612 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for 3613 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver). 3614 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are 3615 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and 3616 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface. 3617 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets. 3618 */ 3619 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info { 3620 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3621 u16 status; 3622 const u8 *ie; 3623 size_t ie_len; 3624 }; 3625 3626 /** 3627 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data 3628 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 3629 * for the entire device 3630 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 3631 * for the given interface 3632 * @global_mcast_rx: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes 3633 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface 3634 * for these subtypes 3635 */ 3636 struct mgmt_frame_regs { 3637 u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes; 3638 u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes; 3639 }; 3640 3641 /** 3642 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration 3643 * 3644 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks 3645 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces. 3646 * 3647 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0 3648 * on success or a negative error code. 3649 * 3650 * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be 3651 * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied 3652 * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering, 3653 * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers. 3654 * 3655 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will 3656 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are 3657 * configured for the device. 3658 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed 3659 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback 3660 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from 3661 * the device. 3662 * 3663 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name, 3664 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create 3665 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct 3666 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must 3667 * also set the address member in the wdev. 3668 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 3669 * 3670 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface 3671 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 3672 * 3673 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface, 3674 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated. 3675 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 3676 * 3677 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL 3678 * when adding a group key. 3679 * 3680 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters. 3681 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group 3682 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid 3683 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is 3684 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist. 3685 * 3686 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key) 3687 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. 3688 * 3689 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface 3690 * 3691 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface 3692 * 3693 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface 3694 * 3695 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver 3696 * 3697 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters. 3698 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode 3699 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started. 3700 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing. 3701 * 3702 * @add_station: Add a new station. 3703 * @del_station: Remove a station 3704 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much 3705 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags 3706 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check 3707 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call 3708 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information. 3709 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac 3710 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3711 * 3712 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path 3713 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path 3714 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path 3715 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters 3716 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3717 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters 3718 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3719 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters 3720 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3721 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network 3722 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3723 * 3724 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration 3725 * 3726 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh. 3727 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to 3728 * set, and which to leave alone. 3729 * 3730 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS. 3731 * 3732 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters 3733 * 3734 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas, 3735 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to 3736 * join the mesh instead. 3737 * 3738 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other 3739 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration. 3740 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should 3741 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active. 3742 * 3743 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given 3744 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done(). 3745 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside 3746 * the scan/scan_done bracket too. 3747 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall 3748 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done(). 3749 * 3750 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer 3751 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3752 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer 3753 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3754 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer 3755 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3756 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer 3757 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3758 * 3759 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected, 3760 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code 3761 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call 3762 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code 3763 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code 3764 * was received. 3765 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the 3766 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated 3767 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches 3768 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request 3769 * frame instead of Association Request frame. 3770 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a 3771 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid 3772 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an 3773 * indication of requesting reassociation. 3774 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming 3775 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to 3776 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3777 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a 3778 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for 3779 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the 3780 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not 3781 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current 3782 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in 3783 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed. 3784 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3785 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if 3786 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in 3787 * case connection was already established (invoked with the 3788 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout(). 3789 * 3790 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call 3791 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due 3792 * to a merge. 3793 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3794 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS. 3795 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3796 * 3797 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or 3798 * MESH mode) 3799 * 3800 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed; 3801 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values 3802 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in 3803 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed. 3804 * 3805 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters, 3806 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The 3807 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will 3808 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power 3809 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.) 3810 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable; 3811 * return 0 if successful 3812 * 3813 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting 3814 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state 3815 * 3816 * @dump_survey: get site survey information. 3817 * 3818 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified 3819 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel 3820 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is 3821 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event 3822 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel(). 3823 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation. 3824 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on 3825 * the duration value. 3826 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame. 3827 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management 3828 * frame on another channel 3829 * 3830 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL 3831 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be 3832 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally, 3833 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the 3834 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data 3835 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present 3836 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA. 3837 * 3838 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration 3839 * 3840 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac 3841 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association 3842 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs. 3843 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID. 3844 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs. 3845 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1 3846 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value. 3847 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold. 3848 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating 3849 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may 3850 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being 3851 * disabled.) 3852 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the 3853 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the 3854 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should 3855 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented. 3856 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config. 3857 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error 3858 * thresholds. 3859 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan. 3860 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with 3861 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready 3862 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be 3863 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case. 3864 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested 3865 * stop (when this method returns 0). 3866 * 3867 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame 3868 * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep. 3869 * 3870 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 3871 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 3872 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 3873 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 3874 * 3875 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 3876 * 3877 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame. 3878 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup). 3879 * 3880 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it 3881 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status(). 3882 * 3883 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs. 3884 * 3885 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface. 3886 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single 3887 * current monitoring channel. 3888 * 3889 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device. 3890 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device. 3891 * 3892 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode. 3893 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations 3894 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver 3895 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL 3896 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which 3897 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback. 3898 * 3899 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver. 3900 * 3901 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC 3902 * was finished on another phy. 3903 * 3904 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the 3905 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be 3906 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames. 3907 * 3908 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability 3909 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the 3910 * driver can take the most appropriate actions. 3911 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link 3912 * reliability. This operation can not fail. 3913 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters. 3914 * 3915 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is 3916 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is 3917 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later 3918 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept 3919 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them 3920 * as soon as possible. 3921 * 3922 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver 3923 * 3924 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the 3925 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width 3926 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS. 3927 * 3928 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device 3929 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by 3930 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into 3931 * account. 3932 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure 3933 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return 3934 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake 3935 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later 3936 * rejected) 3937 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS 3938 * 3939 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters 3940 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3941 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network 3942 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3943 * 3944 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 3945 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 3946 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. 3947 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 3948 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 3949 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface. 3950 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface. 3951 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure. 3952 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and 3953 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver 3954 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling 3955 * cfg80211_free_nan_func(). 3956 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the 3957 * provided @nan_func. 3958 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function. 3959 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must 3960 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes); 3961 * All other parameters must be ignored. 3962 * 3963 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS 3964 * 3965 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this 3966 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise. 3967 * 3968 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake. 3969 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect 3970 * upon which the driver should clear it. 3971 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3972 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator. 3973 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3974 * 3975 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from 3976 * user space 3977 * 3978 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter 3979 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted. 3980 * 3981 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 3982 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 3983 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) 3984 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement 3985 * 3986 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME 3987 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated 3988 * DH IE through this interface. 3989 * 3990 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame 3991 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm. 3992 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific 3993 * This callback may sleep. 3994 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the 3995 * given TIDs. This callback may sleep. 3996 * 3997 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. 3998 */ 3999 struct cfg80211_ops { 4000 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow); 4001 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4002 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled); 4003 4004 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4005 const char *name, 4006 unsigned char name_assign_type, 4007 enum nl80211_iftype type, 4008 struct vif_params *params); 4009 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4010 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4011 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4012 struct net_device *dev, 4013 enum nl80211_iftype type, 4014 struct vif_params *params); 4015 4016 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4017 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr, 4018 struct key_params *params); 4019 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4020 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr, 4021 void *cookie, 4022 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*)); 4023 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4024 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr); 4025 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4026 struct net_device *netdev, 4027 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast); 4028 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4029 struct net_device *netdev, 4030 u8 key_index); 4031 int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4032 struct net_device *netdev, 4033 u8 key_index); 4034 4035 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4036 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings); 4037 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4038 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info); 4039 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4040 4041 4042 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4043 const u8 *mac, 4044 struct station_parameters *params); 4045 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4046 struct station_del_parameters *params); 4047 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4048 const u8 *mac, 4049 struct station_parameters *params); 4050 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4051 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 4052 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4053 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 4054 4055 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4056 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 4057 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4058 const u8 *dst); 4059 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4060 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 4061 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4062 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4063 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4064 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, 4065 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4066 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4067 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4068 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4069 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, 4070 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4071 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4072 struct net_device *dev, 4073 struct mesh_config *conf); 4074 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4075 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask, 4076 const struct mesh_config *nconf); 4077 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4078 const struct mesh_config *conf, 4079 const struct mesh_setup *setup); 4080 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4081 4082 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4083 struct ocb_setup *setup); 4084 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4085 4086 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4087 struct bss_parameters *params); 4088 4089 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4090 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params); 4091 4092 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4093 struct net_device *dev, 4094 struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 4095 4096 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4097 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4098 4099 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4100 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request); 4101 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4102 4103 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4104 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req); 4105 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4106 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req); 4107 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4108 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req); 4109 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4110 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req); 4111 4112 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4113 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme); 4114 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4115 struct net_device *dev, 4116 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme, 4117 u32 changed); 4118 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4119 u16 reason_code); 4120 4121 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4122 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params); 4123 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4124 4125 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4126 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]); 4127 4128 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed); 4129 4130 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4131 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm); 4132 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4133 int *dbm); 4134 4135 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4136 4137 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4138 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4139 void *data, int len); 4140 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb, 4141 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4142 void *data, int len); 4143 #endif 4144 4145 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4146 struct net_device *dev, 4147 const u8 *peer, 4148 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4149 4150 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4151 int idx, struct survey_info *info); 4152 4153 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4154 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4155 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4156 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4157 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev); 4158 4159 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4160 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4161 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4162 unsigned int duration, 4163 u64 *cookie); 4164 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4165 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4166 u64 cookie); 4167 4168 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4169 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params, 4170 u64 *cookie); 4171 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4172 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4173 u64 cookie); 4174 4175 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4176 bool enabled, int timeout); 4177 4178 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4179 struct net_device *dev, 4180 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst); 4181 4182 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4183 struct net_device *dev, 4184 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high); 4185 4186 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4187 struct net_device *dev, 4188 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl); 4189 4190 void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4191 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4192 struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd); 4193 4194 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4195 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4196 4197 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4198 struct net_device *dev, 4199 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request); 4200 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4201 u64 reqid); 4202 4203 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4204 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4205 4206 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4207 const u8 *peer, u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, 4208 u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability, 4209 bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4210 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4211 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper); 4212 4213 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4214 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie); 4215 4216 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4217 struct net_device *dev, 4218 u16 noack_map); 4219 4220 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4221 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4222 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4223 4224 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4225 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4226 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4227 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4228 4229 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4230 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params); 4231 4232 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4233 struct net_device *dev, 4234 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4235 u32 cac_time_ms); 4236 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4237 struct net_device *dev); 4238 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4239 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie); 4240 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4241 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4242 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol, 4243 u16 duration); 4244 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4245 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4246 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4247 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce); 4248 4249 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4250 struct net_device *dev, 4251 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params); 4252 4253 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4254 struct net_device *dev, 4255 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 4256 4257 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4258 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4259 4260 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4261 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio, 4262 u16 admitted_time); 4263 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4264 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer); 4265 4266 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4267 struct net_device *dev, 4268 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class, 4269 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4270 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4271 struct net_device *dev, 4272 const u8 *addr); 4273 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4274 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4275 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4276 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4277 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4278 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4279 u64 cookie); 4280 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4281 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4282 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, 4283 u32 changes); 4284 4285 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4286 struct net_device *dev, 4287 const bool enabled); 4288 4289 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4290 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4291 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats); 4292 4293 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4294 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf); 4295 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4296 const u8 *aa); 4297 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4298 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params); 4299 4300 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4301 struct net_device *dev, 4302 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 4303 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto, 4304 const bool noencrypt, 4305 u64 *cookie); 4306 4307 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4308 struct net_device *dev, 4309 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4310 4311 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4312 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4313 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4314 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4315 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4316 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info); 4317 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4318 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4319 int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4320 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4321 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4322 const u8 *peer, u8 tids); 4323 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4324 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); 4325 }; 4326 4327 /* 4328 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures 4329 * and registration/helper functions 4330 */ 4331 4332 /** 4333 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags 4334 * 4335 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split 4336 * into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB. 4337 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this 4338 * wiphy at all 4339 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled 4340 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default 4341 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good 4342 * reason to override the default 4343 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station 4344 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of 4345 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype. 4346 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station 4347 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the 4348 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the 4349 * control_port_no_encrypt flag. 4350 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN. 4351 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing 4352 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH. 4353 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the 4354 * firmware. 4355 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP. 4356 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation. 4357 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z) 4358 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and 4359 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT 4360 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be 4361 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation. 4362 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME 4363 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes 4364 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling 4365 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(). 4366 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device 4367 * responds to probe-requests in hardware. 4368 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX. 4369 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call. 4370 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels. 4371 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in 4372 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...). 4373 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation 4374 * before connection. 4375 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys 4376 */ 4377 enum wiphy_flags { 4378 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0), 4379 /* use hole at 1 */ 4380 WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ = BIT(2), 4381 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3), 4382 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4), 4383 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5), 4384 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6), 4385 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7), 4386 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8), 4387 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10), 4388 /* use hole at 11 */ 4389 /* use hole at 12 */ 4390 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13), 4391 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14), 4392 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15), 4393 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16), 4394 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17), 4395 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18), 4396 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19), 4397 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20), 4398 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21), 4399 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22), 4400 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23), 4401 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP = BIT(24), 4402 }; 4403 4404 /** 4405 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types 4406 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types 4407 * @types: interface types (bits) 4408 */ 4409 struct ieee80211_iface_limit { 4410 u16 max; 4411 u16 types; 4412 }; 4413 4414 /** 4415 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination 4416 * 4417 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface 4418 * combinations it supports concurrently. 4419 * 4420 * Examples: 4421 * 4422 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total: 4423 * 4424 * .. code-block:: c 4425 * 4426 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = { 4427 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4428 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, }, 4429 * }; 4430 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = { 4431 * .limits = limits1, 4432 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1), 4433 * .max_interfaces = 2, 4434 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true, 4435 * }; 4436 * 4437 * 4438 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total: 4439 * 4440 * .. code-block:: c 4441 * 4442 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = { 4443 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) | 4444 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), }, 4445 * }; 4446 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = { 4447 * .limits = limits2, 4448 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2), 4449 * .max_interfaces = 8, 4450 * .num_different_channels = 1, 4451 * }; 4452 * 4453 * 4454 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total. 4455 * 4456 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections. 4457 * 4458 * .. code-block:: c 4459 * 4460 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = { 4461 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4462 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) | 4463 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), }, 4464 * }; 4465 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = { 4466 * .limits = limits3, 4467 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3), 4468 * .max_interfaces = 4, 4469 * .num_different_channels = 2, 4470 * }; 4471 * 4472 */ 4473 struct ieee80211_iface_combination { 4474 /** 4475 * @limits: 4476 * limits for the given interface types 4477 */ 4478 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits; 4479 4480 /** 4481 * @num_different_channels: 4482 * can use up to this many different channels 4483 */ 4484 u32 num_different_channels; 4485 4486 /** 4487 * @max_interfaces: 4488 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group 4489 */ 4490 u16 max_interfaces; 4491 4492 /** 4493 * @n_limits: 4494 * number of limitations 4495 */ 4496 u8 n_limits; 4497 4498 /** 4499 * @beacon_int_infra_match: 4500 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure 4501 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases. 4502 */ 4503 bool beacon_int_infra_match; 4504 4505 /** 4506 * @radar_detect_widths: 4507 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection 4508 */ 4509 u8 radar_detect_widths; 4510 4511 /** 4512 * @radar_detect_regions: 4513 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection 4514 */ 4515 u8 radar_detect_regions; 4516 4517 /** 4518 * @beacon_int_min_gcd: 4519 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals. 4520 * 4521 * = 0 4522 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same. 4523 * > 0 4524 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND 4525 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this 4526 * combination must be greater or equal to this value. 4527 */ 4528 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd; 4529 }; 4530 4531 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes { 4532 u16 tx, rx; 4533 }; 4534 4535 /** 4536 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags 4537 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any" 4538 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and 4539 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a 4540 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the 4541 * packet should be preserved in that case 4542 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet 4543 * (see nl80211.h) 4544 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect 4545 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep 4546 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure 4547 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request 4548 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure 4549 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release 4550 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection 4551 */ 4552 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags { 4553 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0), 4554 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1), 4555 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2), 4556 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3), 4557 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4), 4558 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5), 4559 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6), 4560 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7), 4561 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8), 4562 }; 4563 4564 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support { 4565 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok; 4566 u32 data_payload_max; 4567 u32 data_interval_max; 4568 u32 wake_payload_max; 4569 bool seq; 4570 }; 4571 4572 /** 4573 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data 4574 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags 4575 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns 4576 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 4577 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 4578 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 4579 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 4580 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect, 4581 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for 4582 * scheduled scans. 4583 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more 4584 * details. 4585 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information 4586 */ 4587 struct wiphy_wowlan_support { 4588 u32 flags; 4589 int n_patterns; 4590 int pattern_max_len; 4591 int pattern_min_len; 4592 int max_pkt_offset; 4593 int max_nd_match_sets; 4594 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp; 4595 }; 4596 4597 /** 4598 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data 4599 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules 4600 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs 4601 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule 4602 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 4603 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 4604 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 4605 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 4606 */ 4607 struct wiphy_coalesce_support { 4608 int n_rules; 4609 int max_delay; 4610 int n_patterns; 4611 int pattern_max_len; 4612 int pattern_min_len; 4613 int max_pkt_offset; 4614 }; 4615 4616 /** 4617 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands 4618 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev 4619 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev 4620 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running 4621 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV) 4622 */ 4623 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags { 4624 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0), 4625 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1), 4626 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2), 4627 }; 4628 4629 /** 4630 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags 4631 * 4632 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed 4633 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed 4634 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed 4635 * 4636 */ 4637 enum wiphy_opmode_flag { 4638 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 4639 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1), 4640 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2), 4641 }; 4642 4643 /** 4644 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information 4645 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag 4646 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station 4647 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station 4648 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station 4649 */ 4650 4651 struct sta_opmode_info { 4652 u32 changed; 4653 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 4654 enum nl80211_chan_width bw; 4655 u8 rx_nss; 4656 }; 4657 4658 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA)) 4659 4660 /** 4661 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition 4662 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211 4663 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags 4664 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the 4665 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data 4666 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all 4667 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The 4668 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple 4669 * dumpit calls. 4670 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. 4671 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the 4672 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command). 4673 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy 4674 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and 4675 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others 4676 * are used with dump requests. 4677 */ 4678 struct wiphy_vendor_command { 4679 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info; 4680 u32 flags; 4681 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4682 const void *data, int data_len); 4683 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4684 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len, 4685 unsigned long *storage); 4686 const struct nla_policy *policy; 4687 unsigned int maxattr; 4688 }; 4689 4690 /** 4691 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type 4692 * @iftype: interface type 4693 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 4694 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the 4695 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are 4696 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std 4697 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. 4698 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 4699 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 4700 */ 4701 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab { 4702 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 4703 const u8 *extended_capabilities; 4704 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask; 4705 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 4706 }; 4707 4708 /** 4709 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities 4710 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement 4711 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement 4712 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement 4713 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported 4714 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported 4715 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported 4716 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data 4717 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data 4718 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble) 4719 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width) 4720 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported 4721 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily 4722 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick) 4723 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if 4724 * not limited) 4725 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported 4726 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported 4727 */ 4728 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities { 4729 unsigned int max_peers; 4730 u8 report_ap_tsf:1, 4731 randomize_mac_addr:1; 4732 4733 struct { 4734 u32 preambles; 4735 u32 bandwidths; 4736 s8 max_bursts_exponent; 4737 u8 max_ftms_per_burst; 4738 u8 supported:1, 4739 asap:1, 4740 non_asap:1, 4741 request_lci:1, 4742 request_civicloc:1, 4743 trigger_based:1, 4744 non_trigger_based:1; 4745 } ftm; 4746 }; 4747 4748 /** 4749 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm 4750 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the 4751 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites. 4752 * 4753 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types 4754 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites 4755 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 4756 */ 4757 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites { 4758 u16 iftypes_mask; 4759 const u32 *akm_suites; 4760 int n_akm_suites; 4761 }; 4762 4763 /** 4764 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description 4765 * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device 4766 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback, 4767 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory() 4768 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL 4769 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via 4770 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver 4771 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future 4772 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers. 4773 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss. 4774 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites 4775 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites 4776 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if 4777 * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in 4778 * iftype_akm_suites. 4779 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 4780 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type. 4781 * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot 4782 * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all 4783 * instances of iftype_akm_suites). 4784 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm 4785 * suites are specified separately. 4786 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit) 4787 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit) 4788 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold); 4789 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used 4790 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled 4791 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in 4792 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device 4793 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking, 4794 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last 4795 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual 4796 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with 4797 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up. 4798 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses. 4799 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer 4800 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used 4801 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to 4802 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle 4803 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses. 4804 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against 4805 * unregister hardware 4806 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>). 4807 * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames 4808 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in 4809 * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev() 4810 * (see below). 4811 * @wext: wireless extension handlers 4812 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter) 4813 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy, 4814 * must be set by driver 4815 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not 4816 * list single interface types. 4817 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array. 4818 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not 4819 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW. 4820 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags 4821 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see 4822 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags 4823 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags. 4824 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see 4825 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index. 4826 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it, 4827 * this variable determines its size 4828 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in 4829 * any given scan 4830 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that 4831 * the device can run concurrently. 4832 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan 4833 * for in any given scheduled scan 4834 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle 4835 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not 4836 * supported. 4837 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can 4838 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not 4839 * include fixed IEs like supported rates 4840 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled 4841 * scans 4842 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number 4843 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device. 4844 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a 4845 * single scan plan supported by the device. 4846 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single 4847 * scan plan supported by the device. 4848 * @coverage_class: current coverage class 4849 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting 4850 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting 4851 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device 4852 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary 4853 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers 4854 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device 4855 * 4856 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or 4857 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface 4858 * type 4859 * 4860 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 4861 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 4862 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set. 4863 * 4864 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 4865 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 4866 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set. 4867 * 4868 * @probe_resp_offload: 4869 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading. 4870 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid 4871 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set. 4872 * 4873 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation 4874 * may request, if implemented. 4875 * 4876 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information 4877 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be 4878 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed 4879 * to the suspend() operation instead. 4880 * 4881 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. 4882 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden. 4883 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 4884 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden. 4885 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 4886 * 4887 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must 4888 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection. 4889 * 4890 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device 4891 * supports for ACL. 4892 * 4893 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 4894 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are 4895 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") 4896 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See 4897 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default 4898 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified 4899 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab. 4900 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 4901 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 4902 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type 4903 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended 4904 * capabilities are specified separately. 4905 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information 4906 * 4907 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware 4908 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands 4909 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware 4910 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events 4911 * 4912 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode 4913 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The 4914 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in 4915 * some cases, but may not always reach. 4916 * 4917 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons 4918 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver 4919 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means 4920 * infinite. 4921 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported 4922 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the 4923 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr. 4924 * 4925 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a 4926 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for 4927 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 4928 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 4929 * 4930 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit 4931 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit 4932 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum 4933 * 4934 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using 4935 * wake_tx_queue 4936 * 4937 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP 4938 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not 4939 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues. 4940 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect. 4941 * 4942 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities 4943 * 4944 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the 4945 * device has 4946 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 4947 * supported by the driver for each vif 4948 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 4949 * supported by the driver for each peer 4950 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for 4951 * long/short retry configuration 4952 * 4953 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for 4954 * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and 4955 * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes 4956 * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities 4957 * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure 4958 */ 4959 struct wiphy { 4960 struct mutex mtx; 4961 4962 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */ 4963 4964 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN]; 4965 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN]; 4966 4967 struct mac_address *addresses; 4968 4969 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes; 4970 4971 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations; 4972 int n_iface_combinations; 4973 u16 software_iftypes; 4974 4975 u16 n_addresses; 4976 4977 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */ 4978 u16 interface_modes; 4979 4980 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs; 4981 4982 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features; 4983 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)]; 4984 4985 u32 ap_sme_capa; 4986 4987 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type; 4988 4989 int bss_priv_size; 4990 u8 max_scan_ssids; 4991 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs; 4992 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids; 4993 u8 max_match_sets; 4994 u16 max_scan_ie_len; 4995 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len; 4996 u32 max_sched_scan_plans; 4997 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval; 4998 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations; 4999 5000 int n_cipher_suites; 5001 const u32 *cipher_suites; 5002 5003 int n_akm_suites; 5004 const u32 *akm_suites; 5005 5006 const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites; 5007 unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites; 5008 5009 u8 retry_short; 5010 u8 retry_long; 5011 u32 frag_threshold; 5012 u32 rts_threshold; 5013 u8 coverage_class; 5014 5015 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN]; 5016 u32 hw_version; 5017 5018 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 5019 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan; 5020 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config; 5021 #endif 5022 5023 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration; 5024 5025 u8 max_num_pmkids; 5026 5027 u32 available_antennas_tx; 5028 u32 available_antennas_rx; 5029 5030 u32 probe_resp_offload; 5031 5032 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask; 5033 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 5034 5035 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab; 5036 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab; 5037 5038 const void *privid; 5039 5040 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 5041 5042 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5043 struct regulatory_request *request); 5044 5045 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */ 5046 5047 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd; 5048 5049 struct device dev; 5050 5051 bool registered; 5052 5053 struct dentry *debugfsdir; 5054 5055 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask; 5056 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask; 5057 5058 struct list_head wdev_list; 5059 5060 possible_net_t _net; 5061 5062 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 5063 const struct iw_handler_def *wext; 5064 #endif 5065 5066 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce; 5067 5068 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands; 5069 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events; 5070 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events; 5071 5072 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta; 5073 5074 u8 max_num_csa_counters; 5075 5076 u32 bss_select_support; 5077 5078 u8 nan_supported_bands; 5079 5080 u32 txq_limit; 5081 u32 txq_memory_limit; 5082 u32 txq_quantum; 5083 5084 unsigned long tx_queue_len; 5085 5086 u8 support_mbssid:1, 5087 support_only_he_mbssid:1; 5088 5089 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa; 5090 5091 struct { 5092 u64 peer, vif; 5093 u8 max_retry; 5094 } tid_config_support; 5095 5096 u8 max_data_retry_count; 5097 5098 const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa; 5099 5100 struct rfkill *rfkill; 5101 5102 char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN); 5103 }; 5104 5105 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5106 { 5107 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net); 5108 } 5109 5110 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net) 5111 { 5112 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net); 5113 } 5114 5115 /** 5116 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy 5117 * 5118 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return 5119 * Return: The priv of @wiphy. 5120 */ 5121 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5122 { 5123 BUG_ON(!wiphy); 5124 return &wiphy->priv; 5125 } 5126 5127 /** 5128 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv 5129 * 5130 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv 5131 * Return: The wiphy of @priv. 5132 */ 5133 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv) 5134 { 5135 BUG_ON(!priv); 5136 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv); 5137 } 5138 5139 /** 5140 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy 5141 * 5142 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind 5143 * @dev: The device to parent it to 5144 */ 5145 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev) 5146 { 5147 wiphy->dev.parent = dev; 5148 } 5149 5150 /** 5151 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer 5152 * 5153 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up 5154 * Return: The dev of @wiphy. 5155 */ 5156 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5157 { 5158 return wiphy->dev.parent; 5159 } 5160 5161 /** 5162 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name 5163 * 5164 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return 5165 * Return: The name of @wiphy. 5166 */ 5167 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy) 5168 { 5169 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev); 5170 } 5171 5172 /** 5173 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5174 * 5175 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5176 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5177 * @requested_name: Request a particular name. 5178 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming. 5179 * 5180 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5181 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5182 * 5183 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5184 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5185 */ 5186 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv, 5187 const char *requested_name); 5188 5189 /** 5190 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5191 * 5192 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5193 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5194 * 5195 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5196 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5197 * 5198 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5199 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5200 */ 5201 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, 5202 int sizeof_priv) 5203 { 5204 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL); 5205 } 5206 5207 /** 5208 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211 5209 * 5210 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register. 5211 * 5212 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code. 5213 */ 5214 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5215 5216 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */ 5217 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx) 5218 5219 /** 5220 * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking 5221 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on 5222 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing 5223 * 5224 * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock() 5225 * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference(). 5226 */ 5227 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p) \ 5228 rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) 5229 5230 /** 5231 * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx 5232 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on 5233 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing 5234 * 5235 * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the 5236 * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates. 5237 */ 5238 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p) \ 5239 rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) 5240 5241 /** 5242 * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy 5243 * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from 5244 */ 5245 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5246 5247 /** 5248 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211 5249 * 5250 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister. 5251 * 5252 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv 5253 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding 5254 * request that is being handled. 5255 */ 5256 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5257 5258 /** 5259 * wiphy_free - free wiphy 5260 * 5261 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free 5262 */ 5263 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5264 5265 /* internal structs */ 5266 struct cfg80211_conn; 5267 struct cfg80211_internal_bss; 5268 struct cfg80211_cached_keys; 5269 struct cfg80211_cqm_config; 5270 5271 /** 5272 * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy 5273 * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock 5274 * 5275 * This is mostly exposed so it can be done around registering and 5276 * unregistering netdevs that aren't created through cfg80211 calls, 5277 * since that requires locking in cfg80211 when the notifiers is 5278 * called, but that cannot differentiate which way it's called. 5279 * 5280 * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked. 5281 */ 5282 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5283 __acquires(&wiphy->mtx) 5284 { 5285 mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx); 5286 __acquire(&wiphy->mtx); 5287 } 5288 5289 /** 5290 * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again 5291 * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock 5292 */ 5293 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5294 __releases(&wiphy->mtx) 5295 { 5296 __release(&wiphy->mtx); 5297 mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx); 5298 } 5299 5300 /** 5301 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state 5302 * 5303 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver 5304 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this 5305 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.) 5306 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will 5307 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device, 5308 * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or 5309 * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops 5310 * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.) 5311 * 5312 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver 5313 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as 5314 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be 5315 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it. 5316 * 5317 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description 5318 * @iftype: interface type 5319 * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211 5320 * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock 5321 * for the notifier 5322 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces 5323 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL 5324 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this 5325 * wireless device if it has no netdev 5326 * @current_bss: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5327 * @chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to track 5328 * the user-set channel definition. 5329 * @preset_chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to 5330 * track the channel to be used for AP later 5331 * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5332 * @ssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5333 * @ssid_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5334 * @mesh_id_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5335 * @mesh_id_up_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5336 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code 5337 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling 5338 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data 5339 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data 5340 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association 5341 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements 5342 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID 5343 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID 5344 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index 5345 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index 5346 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation 5347 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity 5348 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be 5349 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the 5350 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update 5351 * by cfg80211 on change_interface 5352 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames 5353 * @mgmt_registrations_lock: lock for the list 5354 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated, 5355 * need to propagate the update to the driver 5356 * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers 5357 * and some API functions require it held 5358 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting 5359 * beacons, 0 when not valid 5360 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL 5361 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g. 5362 * the P2P Device. 5363 * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started 5364 * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 5365 * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms 5366 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled 5367 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout 5368 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application 5369 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode) 5370 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data 5371 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established 5372 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type 5373 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID 5374 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work 5375 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect 5376 * @ibss_fixed: (private) IBSS is using fixed BSSID 5377 * @ibss_dfs_possible: (private) IBSS may change to a DFS channel 5378 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing 5379 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list 5380 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID 5381 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away 5382 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state 5383 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests 5384 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock 5385 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work 5386 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last 5387 * unprotected beacon report 5388 */ 5389 struct wireless_dev { 5390 struct wiphy *wiphy; 5391 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 5392 5393 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */ 5394 struct list_head list; 5395 struct net_device *netdev; 5396 5397 u32 identifier; 5398 5399 struct list_head mgmt_registrations; 5400 spinlock_t mgmt_registrations_lock; 5401 u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1; 5402 5403 struct mutex mtx; 5404 5405 bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering; 5406 5407 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16)); 5408 5409 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */ 5410 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 5411 u8 ssid_len, mesh_id_len, mesh_id_up_len; 5412 struct cfg80211_conn *conn; 5413 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys; 5414 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type; 5415 u32 conn_owner_nlportid; 5416 5417 struct work_struct disconnect_wk; 5418 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5419 5420 struct list_head event_list; 5421 spinlock_t event_lock; 5422 5423 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; /* associated / joined */ 5424 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; 5425 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 5426 5427 bool ibss_fixed; 5428 bool ibss_dfs_possible; 5429 5430 bool ps; 5431 int ps_timeout; 5432 5433 int beacon_interval; 5434 5435 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid; 5436 5437 u32 owner_nlportid; 5438 bool nl_owner_dead; 5439 5440 bool cac_started; 5441 unsigned long cac_start_time; 5442 unsigned int cac_time_ms; 5443 5444 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 5445 /* wext data */ 5446 struct { 5447 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss; 5448 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect; 5449 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys; 5450 const u8 *ie; 5451 size_t ie_len; 5452 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5453 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5454 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 5455 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key; 5456 bool prev_bssid_valid; 5457 } wext; 5458 #endif 5459 5460 struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config; 5461 5462 struct list_head pmsr_list; 5463 spinlock_t pmsr_lock; 5464 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk; 5465 5466 unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported; 5467 }; 5468 5469 static inline u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5470 { 5471 if (wdev->netdev) 5472 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr; 5473 return wdev->address; 5474 } 5475 5476 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5477 { 5478 if (wdev->netdev) 5479 return netif_running(wdev->netdev); 5480 return wdev->is_running; 5481 } 5482 5483 /** 5484 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev 5485 * 5486 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return 5487 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev. 5488 */ 5489 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5490 { 5491 BUG_ON(!wdev); 5492 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy); 5493 } 5494 5495 /** 5496 * DOC: Utility functions 5497 * 5498 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful. 5499 */ 5500 5501 /** 5502 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel 5503 * 5504 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel 5505 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel 5506 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b 5507 */ 5508 static inline bool 5509 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a, 5510 struct ieee80211_channel *b) 5511 { 5512 return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq && 5513 a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset); 5514 } 5515 5516 /** 5517 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz 5518 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert 5519 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz) 5520 */ 5521 static inline u32 5522 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 5523 { 5524 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset; 5525 } 5526 5527 /** 5528 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan 5529 * 5530 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ 5531 * @chan: channel 5532 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq 5533 */ 5534 enum nl80211_chan_width 5535 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 5536 5537 /** 5538 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency 5539 * @chan: channel number 5540 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 5541 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 5542 */ 5543 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band); 5544 5545 /** 5546 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency 5547 * @chan: channel number 5548 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 5549 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 5550 */ 5551 static inline int 5552 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band) 5553 { 5554 return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band)); 5555 } 5556 5557 /** 5558 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 5559 * @freq: center frequency in KHz 5560 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 5561 */ 5562 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq); 5563 5564 /** 5565 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 5566 * @freq: center frequency in MHz 5567 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 5568 */ 5569 static inline int 5570 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq) 5571 { 5572 return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 5573 } 5574 5575 /** 5576 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified 5577 * frequency 5578 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 5579 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel 5580 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 5581 */ 5582 struct ieee80211_channel * 5583 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq); 5584 5585 /** 5586 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency 5587 * 5588 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 5589 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel 5590 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 5591 */ 5592 static inline struct ieee80211_channel * 5593 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq) 5594 { 5595 return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 5596 } 5597 5598 /** 5599 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC 5600 * @chan: control channel to check 5601 * 5602 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in 5603 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3 5604 */ 5605 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 5606 { 5607 if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ) 5608 return false; 5609 5610 return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5; 5611 } 5612 5613 /** 5614 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate 5615 * 5616 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 5617 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates 5618 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate 5619 * 5620 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that 5621 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map, 5622 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of 5623 * rates in the band's bitrate table. 5624 */ 5625 const struct ieee80211_rate * 5626 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 5627 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate); 5628 5629 /** 5630 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band 5631 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 5632 * @scan_width: width of the control channel 5633 * 5634 * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given 5635 * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array. 5636 */ 5637 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 5638 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width); 5639 5640 /* 5641 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support 5642 * 5643 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c 5644 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst 5645 */ 5646 5647 struct radiotap_align_size { 5648 uint8_t align:4, size:4; 5649 }; 5650 5651 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace { 5652 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size; 5653 int n_bits; 5654 uint32_t oui; 5655 uint8_t subns; 5656 }; 5657 5658 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces { 5659 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns; 5660 int n_ns; 5661 }; 5662 5663 /** 5664 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args 5665 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call 5666 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() 5667 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each 5668 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after 5669 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to 5670 * the beginning of the actual data portion 5671 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience 5672 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition 5673 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown) 5674 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default 5675 * radiotap namespace or not 5676 * 5677 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through 5678 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering 5679 * @_arg_index: next argument index 5680 * @_arg: next argument pointer 5681 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32 5682 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present 5683 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions 5684 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data 5685 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the 5686 * next bitmap word 5687 * 5688 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore 5689 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally. 5690 */ 5691 5692 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator { 5693 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader; 5694 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns; 5695 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace; 5696 5697 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data; 5698 __le32 *_next_bitmap; 5699 5700 unsigned char *this_arg; 5701 int this_arg_index; 5702 int this_arg_size; 5703 5704 int is_radiotap_ns; 5705 5706 int _max_length; 5707 int _arg_index; 5708 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter; 5709 int _reset_on_ext; 5710 }; 5711 5712 int 5713 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator, 5714 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header, 5715 int max_length, 5716 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns); 5717 5718 int 5719 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator); 5720 5721 5722 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6]; 5723 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6]; 5724 5725 /** 5726 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data 5727 * 5728 * @skb: the frame 5729 * 5730 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function 5731 * returns the 802.11 header length. 5732 * 5733 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption 5734 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid 5735 * 802.11 header. 5736 */ 5737 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb); 5738 5739 /** 5740 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control 5741 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format 5742 * Return: The header length in bytes. 5743 */ 5744 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc); 5745 5746 /** 5747 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length 5748 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field 5749 * (first byte) will be accessed 5750 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at 5751 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present. 5752 */ 5753 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr); 5754 5755 /** 5756 * DOC: Data path helpers 5757 * 5758 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers 5759 * functions that help implement the data path for devices 5760 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device. 5761 */ 5762 5763 /** 5764 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 5765 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 5766 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead 5767 * of it being pushed into the SKB 5768 * @addr: the device MAC address 5769 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 5770 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header 5771 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 5772 */ 5773 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr, 5774 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 5775 u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu); 5776 5777 /** 5778 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 5779 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 5780 * @addr: the device MAC address 5781 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 5782 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 5783 */ 5784 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr, 5785 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 5786 { 5787 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false); 5788 } 5789 5790 /** 5791 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame 5792 * 5793 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames. 5794 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully 5795 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function. 5796 * 5797 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. 5798 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and 5799 * initialized by the caller. 5800 * @addr: The device MAC address. 5801 * @iftype: The device interface type. 5802 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list. 5803 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 5804 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 5805 */ 5806 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list, 5807 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 5808 const unsigned int extra_headroom, 5809 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa); 5810 5811 /** 5812 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame 5813 * @skb: the data frame 5814 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use 5815 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag. 5816 */ 5817 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb, 5818 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 5819 5820 /** 5821 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data 5822 * 5823 * @eid: element ID 5824 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5825 * @len: length of data 5826 * @match: byte array to match 5827 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 5828 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match. 5829 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers 5830 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take 5831 * the data portion instead. 5832 * 5833 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5834 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5835 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5836 * requested element struct. 5837 * 5838 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5839 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 5840 * byte array to match. 5841 */ 5842 const struct element * 5843 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 5844 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 5845 unsigned int match_offset); 5846 5847 /** 5848 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data 5849 * 5850 * @eid: element ID 5851 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5852 * @len: length of data 5853 * @match: byte array to match 5854 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 5855 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match. 5856 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero. 5857 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first 5858 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and 5859 * the second byte is the IE length. 5860 * 5861 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5862 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5863 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first 5864 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 5865 * element ID. 5866 * 5867 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5868 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 5869 * byte array to match. 5870 */ 5871 static inline const u8 * 5872 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 5873 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 5874 unsigned int match_offset) 5875 { 5876 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is 5877 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well. 5878 */ 5879 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) || 5880 (!match_len && match_offset))) 5881 return NULL; 5882 5883 return (void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, 5884 match, match_len, 5885 match_offset ? 5886 match_offset - 2 : 0); 5887 } 5888 5889 /** 5890 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data 5891 * 5892 * @eid: element ID 5893 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5894 * @len: length of data 5895 * 5896 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5897 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5898 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5899 * requested element struct. 5900 * 5901 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5902 * having to fit into the given data. 5903 */ 5904 static inline const struct element * 5905 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5906 { 5907 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 5908 } 5909 5910 /** 5911 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data 5912 * 5913 * @eid: element ID 5914 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5915 * @len: length of data 5916 * 5917 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5918 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5919 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 5920 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 5921 * 5922 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5923 * having to fit into the given data. 5924 */ 5925 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5926 { 5927 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 5928 } 5929 5930 /** 5931 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data 5932 * 5933 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 5934 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5935 * @len: length of data 5936 * 5937 * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if 5938 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5939 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5940 * requested element struct. 5941 * 5942 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5943 * having to fit into the given data. 5944 */ 5945 static inline const struct element * 5946 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5947 { 5948 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 5949 &ext_eid, 1, 0); 5950 } 5951 5952 /** 5953 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data 5954 * 5955 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 5956 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5957 * @len: length of data 5958 * 5959 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if 5960 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5961 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 5962 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 5963 * 5964 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5965 * having to fit into the given data. 5966 */ 5967 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5968 { 5969 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 5970 &ext_eid, 1, 2); 5971 } 5972 5973 /** 5974 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data 5975 * 5976 * @oui: vendor OUI 5977 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 5978 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5979 * @len: length of data 5980 * 5981 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 5982 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise 5983 * return the element structure for the requested element. 5984 * 5985 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 5986 * the given data. 5987 */ 5988 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 5989 const u8 *ies, 5990 unsigned int len); 5991 5992 /** 5993 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data 5994 * 5995 * @oui: vendor OUI 5996 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 5997 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5998 * @len: length of data 5999 * 6000 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 6001 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to 6002 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 6003 * element ID. 6004 * 6005 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 6006 * the given data. 6007 */ 6008 static inline const u8 * 6009 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 6010 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len) 6011 { 6012 return (void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len); 6013 } 6014 6015 /** 6016 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame 6017 * 6018 * @dev: network device 6019 * @addr: STA MAC address 6020 * 6021 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge 6022 * devices upon STA association. 6023 */ 6024 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 6025 6026 /** 6027 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure 6028 * 6029 * TODO 6030 */ 6031 6032 /** 6033 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain 6034 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting 6035 * conflicts) 6036 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain 6037 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you 6038 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted 6039 * alpha2. 6040 * 6041 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core 6042 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by 6043 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory 6044 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain. 6045 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried 6046 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country. 6047 * 6048 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call. 6049 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(), 6050 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw(). 6051 * 6052 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 6053 * an -ENOMEM. 6054 * 6055 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM. 6056 */ 6057 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2); 6058 6059 /** 6060 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers 6061 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6062 * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy 6063 * 6064 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they 6065 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more 6066 * information. 6067 * 6068 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 6069 */ 6070 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6071 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 6072 6073 /** 6074 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers 6075 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6076 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy 6077 * 6078 * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and 6079 * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details 6080 * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(). 6081 * 6082 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 6083 */ 6084 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6085 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 6086 6087 /** 6088 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain 6089 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6090 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy 6091 * 6092 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply 6093 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory 6094 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The 6095 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous 6096 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a 6097 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled. 6098 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag 6099 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy 6100 * that called this helper. 6101 */ 6102 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6103 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd); 6104 6105 /** 6106 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency 6107 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for 6108 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for 6109 * 6110 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on 6111 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain 6112 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received 6113 * and processed already. 6114 * 6115 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule 6116 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to 6117 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return 6118 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even 6119 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band. 6120 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is 6121 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific. 6122 */ 6123 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6124 u32 center_freq); 6125 6126 /** 6127 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name 6128 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator 6129 * 6130 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a 6131 * proper string representation. 6132 */ 6133 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator); 6134 6135 /** 6136 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom 6137 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked. 6138 * 6139 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI). 6140 */ 6141 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6142 6143 /** 6144 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions 6145 * 6146 */ 6147 6148 /** 6149 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule 6150 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively 6151 * 6152 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried. 6153 * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried. 6154 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db. 6155 * 6156 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query 6157 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given 6158 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations. 6159 * 6160 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 6161 * an -ENODATA. 6162 * 6163 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA. 6164 */ 6165 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq, 6166 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule); 6167 6168 /* 6169 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification 6170 * functions and BSS handling helpers 6171 */ 6172 6173 /** 6174 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished 6175 * 6176 * @request: the corresponding scan request 6177 * @info: information about the completed scan 6178 */ 6179 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request, 6180 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 6181 6182 /** 6183 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available 6184 * 6185 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results 6186 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6187 */ 6188 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6189 6190 /** 6191 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6192 * 6193 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6194 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6195 * 6196 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 6197 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 6198 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 6199 */ 6200 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6201 6202 /** 6203 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6204 * 6205 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6206 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6207 * 6208 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 6209 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 6210 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 6211 * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held. 6212 */ 6213 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6214 6215 /** 6216 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame 6217 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 6218 * @data: the BSS metadata 6219 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon) 6220 * @len: length of the management frame 6221 * @gfp: context flags 6222 * 6223 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 6224 * the BSS should be updated/added. 6225 * 6226 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 6227 * Or %NULL on error. 6228 */ 6229 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6230 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6231 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 6232 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6233 gfp_t gfp); 6234 6235 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6236 cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6237 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6238 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, 6239 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6240 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6241 { 6242 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6243 .chan = rx_channel, 6244 .scan_width = scan_width, 6245 .signal = signal, 6246 }; 6247 6248 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 6249 } 6250 6251 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6252 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6253 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6254 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6255 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6256 { 6257 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6258 .chan = rx_channel, 6259 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 6260 .signal = signal, 6261 }; 6262 6263 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 6264 } 6265 6266 /** 6267 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID 6268 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID 6269 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element 6270 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element 6271 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID 6272 */ 6273 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid, 6274 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid) 6275 { 6276 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid); 6277 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0); 6278 u64 new_bssid_u64; 6279 6280 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask; 6281 6282 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask; 6283 6284 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid); 6285 } 6286 6287 /** 6288 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited 6289 * @element: element to check 6290 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element 6291 */ 6292 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element, 6293 const struct element *non_inherit_element); 6294 6295 /** 6296 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs 6297 * @ie: ies 6298 * @ielen: length of IEs 6299 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element 6300 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile) 6301 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile 6302 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length 6303 */ 6304 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6305 const struct element *mbssid_elem, 6306 const struct element *sub_elem, 6307 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len); 6308 6309 /** 6310 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from 6311 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is 6312 * from a beacon or probe response 6313 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon 6314 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response 6315 */ 6316 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type { 6317 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN, 6318 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON, 6319 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP, 6320 }; 6321 6322 /** 6323 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS 6324 * 6325 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 6326 * @data: the BSS metadata 6327 * @ftype: frame type (if known) 6328 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS 6329 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0) 6330 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer 6331 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer 6332 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer 6333 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs 6334 * @gfp: context flags 6335 * 6336 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 6337 * the BSS should be updated/added. 6338 * 6339 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 6340 * Or %NULL on error. 6341 */ 6342 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6343 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6344 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 6345 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6346 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6347 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6348 gfp_t gfp); 6349 6350 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6351 cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6352 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6353 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, 6354 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6355 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6356 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6357 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6358 { 6359 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6360 .chan = rx_channel, 6361 .scan_width = scan_width, 6362 .signal = signal, 6363 }; 6364 6365 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 6366 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 6367 gfp); 6368 } 6369 6370 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6371 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6372 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6373 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6374 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6375 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6376 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6377 { 6378 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6379 .chan = rx_channel, 6380 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 6381 .signal = signal, 6382 }; 6383 6384 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 6385 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 6386 gfp); 6387 } 6388 6389 /** 6390 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference 6391 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6392 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL) 6393 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL) 6394 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL) 6395 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0) 6396 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type 6397 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy 6398 */ 6399 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6400 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 6401 const u8 *bssid, 6402 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 6403 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type, 6404 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy); 6405 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * 6406 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6407 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 6408 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len) 6409 { 6410 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len, 6411 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 6412 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY); 6413 } 6414 6415 /** 6416 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct 6417 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6418 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference 6419 * 6420 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct. 6421 */ 6422 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6423 6424 /** 6425 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct 6426 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6427 * @bss: the BSS struct 6428 * 6429 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct. 6430 */ 6431 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6432 6433 /** 6434 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures 6435 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6436 * @bss: the bss to remove 6437 * 6438 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures 6439 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this 6440 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time 6441 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all. 6442 */ 6443 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6444 6445 /** 6446 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries 6447 * 6448 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy 6449 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not 6450 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB. 6451 * 6452 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6453 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel 6454 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel. 6455 * @iter: the iterator function to call 6456 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function 6457 */ 6458 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6459 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6460 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6461 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 6462 void *data), 6463 void *iter_data); 6464 6465 static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width 6466 cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 6467 { 6468 switch (chandef->width) { 6469 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 6470 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5; 6471 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 6472 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10; 6473 default: 6474 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20; 6475 } 6476 } 6477 6478 /** 6479 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame 6480 * @dev: network device 6481 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body) 6482 * @len: length of the frame data 6483 * 6484 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or 6485 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode. 6486 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must 6487 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6488 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 6489 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6490 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed 6491 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used 6492 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function 6493 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead. 6494 * 6495 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6496 */ 6497 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6498 6499 /** 6500 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication 6501 * @dev: network device 6502 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out 6503 * 6504 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's 6505 * mutex. 6506 */ 6507 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 6508 6509 /** 6510 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response 6511 * @dev: network device 6512 * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer 6513 * moves to cfg80211 in this call 6514 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body) 6515 * @len: length of the frame data 6516 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format 6517 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 6518 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame 6519 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data 6520 * 6521 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 6522 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6523 * 6524 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6525 */ 6526 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev, 6527 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 6528 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 6529 int uapsd_queues, 6530 const u8 *req_ies, size_t req_ies_len); 6531 6532 /** 6533 * cfg80211_assoc_timeout - notification of timed out association 6534 * @dev: network device 6535 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association timed out. 6536 * 6537 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6538 */ 6539 void cfg80211_assoc_timeout(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6540 6541 /** 6542 * cfg80211_abandon_assoc - notify cfg80211 of abandoned association attempt 6543 * @dev: network device 6544 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association was abandoned. 6545 * 6546 * Call this whenever - for reasons reported through other API, like deauth RX, 6547 * an association attempt was abandoned. 6548 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6549 */ 6550 void cfg80211_abandon_assoc(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6551 6552 /** 6553 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame 6554 * @dev: network device 6555 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body) 6556 * @len: length of the frame data 6557 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute) 6558 * 6559 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in 6560 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and 6561 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the 6562 * corresponding wdev's mutex. 6563 */ 6564 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 6565 bool reconnect); 6566 6567 /** 6568 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame 6569 * @dev: network device 6570 * @buf: received management frame (header + body) 6571 * @len: length of the frame data 6572 * 6573 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc 6574 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the 6575 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon 6576 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while 6577 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). 6578 * 6579 * This function may sleep. 6580 */ 6581 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, 6582 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6583 6584 /** 6585 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP) 6586 * @dev: network device 6587 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame 6588 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used 6589 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing. 6590 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets) 6591 * @gfp: allocation flags 6592 * 6593 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a 6594 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() 6595 * primitive. 6596 */ 6597 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 6598 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id, 6599 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp); 6600 6601 /** 6602 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS 6603 * 6604 * @dev: network device 6605 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined 6606 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined 6607 * @gfp: allocation flags 6608 * 6609 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or 6610 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called, 6611 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of 6612 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called 6613 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is 6614 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest. 6615 */ 6616 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6617 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp); 6618 6619 /** 6620 * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer 6621 * candidate 6622 * 6623 * @dev: network device 6624 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate 6625 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate 6626 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer 6627 * @gfp: allocation flags 6628 * 6629 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been 6630 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response. 6631 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace. 6632 */ 6633 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev, 6634 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len, 6635 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp); 6636 6637 /** 6638 * DOC: RFkill integration 6639 * 6640 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers, 6641 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each 6642 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated 6643 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are 6644 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down. 6645 * 6646 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they 6647 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211. 6648 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here. 6649 */ 6650 6651 /** 6652 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state 6653 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6654 * @blocked: block status 6655 * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons 6656 */ 6657 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked, 6658 enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason); 6659 6660 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked) 6661 { 6662 wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked, 6663 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL); 6664 } 6665 6666 /** 6667 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill 6668 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6669 */ 6670 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6671 6672 /** 6673 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill 6674 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6675 */ 6676 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy) 6677 { 6678 rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill); 6679 } 6680 6681 /** 6682 * DOC: Vendor commands 6683 * 6684 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that 6685 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the 6686 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with 6687 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as 6688 * the configuration mechanism. 6689 * 6690 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array 6691 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an 6692 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it. 6693 * 6694 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol 6695 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular, 6696 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any 6697 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection 6698 * managers etc. need. 6699 */ 6700 6701 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6702 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 6703 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 6704 int approxlen); 6705 6706 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6707 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6708 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 6709 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 6710 unsigned int portid, 6711 int vendor_event_idx, 6712 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp); 6713 6714 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp); 6715 6716 /** 6717 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply 6718 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6719 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6720 * be put into the skb 6721 * 6722 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 6723 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 6724 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid. 6725 * 6726 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in 6727 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 6728 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 6729 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 6730 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 6731 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute. 6732 * You must not modify the skb in any other way. 6733 * 6734 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return 6735 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation. 6736 * 6737 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6738 */ 6739 static inline struct sk_buff * 6740 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 6741 { 6742 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6743 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen); 6744 } 6745 6746 /** 6747 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb 6748 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6749 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb() 6750 * 6751 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 6752 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should 6753 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the 6754 * skb regardless of the return value. 6755 * 6756 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 6757 */ 6758 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb); 6759 6760 /** 6761 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID 6762 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6763 * 6764 * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler. 6765 * Valid to call only there. 6766 */ 6767 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6768 6769 /** 6770 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb 6771 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6772 * @wdev: the wireless device 6773 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 6774 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6775 * be put into the skb 6776 * @gfp: allocation flags 6777 * 6778 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 6779 * vendor-specific multicast group. 6780 * 6781 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 6782 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 6783 * attribute. 6784 * 6785 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 6786 * skb to send the event. 6787 * 6788 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6789 */ 6790 static inline struct sk_buff * 6791 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6792 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 6793 { 6794 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6795 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 6796 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 6797 } 6798 6799 /** 6800 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb 6801 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6802 * @wdev: the wireless device 6803 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 6804 * @portid: port ID of the receiver 6805 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6806 * be put into the skb 6807 * @gfp: allocation flags 6808 * 6809 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to 6810 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been 6811 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take 6812 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes. 6813 * 6814 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 6815 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 6816 * attribute. 6817 * 6818 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 6819 * skb to send the event. 6820 * 6821 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6822 */ 6823 static inline struct sk_buff * 6824 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6825 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6826 unsigned int portid, int approxlen, 6827 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 6828 { 6829 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6830 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 6831 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 6832 } 6833 6834 /** 6835 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event 6836 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc() 6837 * @gfp: allocation flags 6838 * 6839 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 6840 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it. 6841 */ 6842 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 6843 { 6844 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 6845 } 6846 6847 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 6848 /** 6849 * DOC: Test mode 6850 * 6851 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to 6852 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance, 6853 * factory programming. 6854 * 6855 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more 6856 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it. 6857 */ 6858 6859 /** 6860 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply 6861 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6862 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6863 * be put into the skb 6864 * 6865 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 6866 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 6867 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid. 6868 * 6869 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in 6870 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 6871 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 6872 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 6873 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 6874 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You 6875 * must not modify the skb in any other way. 6876 * 6877 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return 6878 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation. 6879 * 6880 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6881 */ 6882 static inline struct sk_buff * 6883 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 6884 { 6885 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 6886 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen); 6887 } 6888 6889 /** 6890 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb 6891 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6892 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() 6893 * 6894 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 6895 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return 6896 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb 6897 * regardless of the return value. 6898 * 6899 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 6900 */ 6901 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb) 6902 { 6903 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb); 6904 } 6905 6906 /** 6907 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event 6908 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6909 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6910 * be put into the skb 6911 * @gfp: allocation flags 6912 * 6913 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 6914 * testmode multicast group. 6915 * 6916 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with 6917 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As 6918 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the 6919 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb 6920 * in any other way. 6921 * 6922 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the 6923 * skb to send the event. 6924 * 6925 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6926 */ 6927 static inline struct sk_buff * 6928 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp) 6929 { 6930 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 6931 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1, 6932 approxlen, gfp); 6933 } 6934 6935 /** 6936 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event 6937 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6938 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb() 6939 * @gfp: allocation flags 6940 * 6941 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 6942 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always 6943 * consumes it. 6944 */ 6945 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 6946 { 6947 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 6948 } 6949 6950 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd), 6951 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd), 6952 #else 6953 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) 6954 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) 6955 #endif 6956 6957 /** 6958 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params 6959 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL) 6960 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets 6961 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in 6962 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid. 6963 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in 6964 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the 6965 * status for a FILS connection. 6966 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL). 6967 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets 6968 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID 6969 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL). 6970 */ 6971 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params { 6972 const u8 *kek; 6973 size_t kek_len; 6974 bool update_erp_next_seq_num; 6975 u16 erp_next_seq_num; 6976 const u8 *pmk; 6977 size_t pmk_len; 6978 const u8 *pmkid; 6979 }; 6980 6981 /** 6982 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params 6983 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 6984 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 6985 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 6986 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 6987 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 6988 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 6989 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 6990 * case. 6991 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL) 6992 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 6993 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 6994 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 6995 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 6996 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 6997 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 6998 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL) 6999 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length 7000 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7001 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length 7002 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters. 7003 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 7004 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 7005 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 7006 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 7007 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 7008 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 7009 */ 7010 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params { 7011 int status; 7012 const u8 *bssid; 7013 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 7014 const u8 *req_ie; 7015 size_t req_ie_len; 7016 const u8 *resp_ie; 7017 size_t resp_ie_len; 7018 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 7019 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason; 7020 }; 7021 7022 /** 7023 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7024 * 7025 * @dev: network device 7026 * @params: connection response parameters 7027 * @gfp: allocation flags 7028 * 7029 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7030 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7031 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response 7032 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), 7033 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(), 7034 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7035 */ 7036 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev, 7037 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params, 7038 gfp_t gfp); 7039 7040 /** 7041 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7042 * 7043 * @dev: network device 7044 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7045 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 7046 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 7047 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 7048 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 7049 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 7050 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 7051 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7052 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7053 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7054 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7055 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7056 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7057 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 7058 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 7059 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 7060 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 7061 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 7062 * case. 7063 * @gfp: allocation flags 7064 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 7065 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 7066 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 7067 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 7068 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 7069 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 7070 * 7071 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7072 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7073 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss 7074 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among 7075 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7076 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7077 */ 7078 static inline void 7079 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7080 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie, 7081 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie, 7082 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp, 7083 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 7084 { 7085 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params; 7086 7087 memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params)); 7088 params.status = status; 7089 params.bssid = bssid; 7090 params.bss = bss; 7091 params.req_ie = req_ie; 7092 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len; 7093 params.resp_ie = resp_ie; 7094 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len; 7095 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason; 7096 7097 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp); 7098 } 7099 7100 /** 7101 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7102 * 7103 * @dev: network device 7104 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7105 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7106 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7107 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7108 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7109 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7110 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7111 * the real status code for failures. 7112 * @gfp: allocation flags 7113 * 7114 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7115 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7116 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only 7117 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7118 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7119 */ 7120 static inline void 7121 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7122 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, 7123 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len, 7124 u16 status, gfp_t gfp) 7125 { 7126 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie, 7127 resp_ie_len, status, gfp, 7128 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED); 7129 } 7130 7131 /** 7132 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout 7133 * 7134 * @dev: network device 7135 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7136 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7137 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7138 * @gfp: allocation flags 7139 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. 7140 * 7141 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed 7142 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was 7143 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send 7144 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while 7145 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among 7146 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7147 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7148 */ 7149 static inline void 7150 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7151 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp, 7152 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 7153 { 7154 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1, 7155 gfp, timeout_reason); 7156 } 7157 7158 /** 7159 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information 7160 * 7161 * @channel: the channel of the new AP 7162 * @bss: entry of bss to which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %bssid is set) 7163 * @bssid: the BSSID of the new AP (may be %NULL if %bss is set) 7164 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7165 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7166 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7167 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7168 * @fils: FILS related roaming information. 7169 */ 7170 struct cfg80211_roam_info { 7171 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 7172 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 7173 const u8 *bssid; 7174 const u8 *req_ie; 7175 size_t req_ie_len; 7176 const u8 *resp_ie; 7177 size_t resp_ie_len; 7178 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 7179 }; 7180 7181 /** 7182 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming 7183 * 7184 * @dev: network device 7185 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info. 7186 * @gfp: allocation flags 7187 * 7188 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the 7189 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry. 7190 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP 7191 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in 7192 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where 7193 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the 7194 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling 7195 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released 7196 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be 7197 * released while disconnecting from the current bss. 7198 */ 7199 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info, 7200 gfp_t gfp); 7201 7202 /** 7203 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association 7204 * 7205 * @dev: network device 7206 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7207 * @gfp: allocation flags 7208 * 7209 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake 7210 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e., 7211 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function 7212 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(), 7213 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to 7214 * indicate the 802.11 association. 7215 */ 7216 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7217 gfp_t gfp); 7218 7219 /** 7220 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped 7221 * 7222 * @dev: network device 7223 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL) 7224 * @ie_len: length of IEs 7225 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown 7226 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally 7227 * @gfp: allocation flags 7228 * 7229 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state 7230 * and not try to connect to any AP any more. 7231 */ 7232 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason, 7233 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len, 7234 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp); 7235 7236 /** 7237 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start 7238 * @wdev: wireless device 7239 * @cookie: the request cookie 7240 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 7241 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the 7242 * channel 7243 * @gfp: allocation flags 7244 */ 7245 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7246 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 7247 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp); 7248 7249 /** 7250 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 7251 * @wdev: wireless device 7252 * @cookie: the request cookie 7253 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 7254 * @gfp: allocation flags 7255 */ 7256 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7257 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 7258 gfp_t gfp); 7259 7260 /** 7261 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired 7262 * @wdev: wireless device 7263 * @cookie: the requested cookie 7264 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request) 7265 * @gfp: allocation flags 7266 */ 7267 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7268 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp); 7269 7270 /** 7271 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics. 7272 * 7273 * @sinfo: the station information 7274 * @gfp: allocation flags 7275 */ 7276 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7277 7278 /** 7279 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info 7280 * @sinfo: the station information 7281 * 7282 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station 7283 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on 7284 * the stack.) 7285 */ 7286 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo) 7287 { 7288 kfree(sinfo->pertid); 7289 } 7290 7291 /** 7292 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station 7293 * 7294 * @dev: the netdev 7295 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7296 * @sinfo: the station information 7297 * @gfp: allocation flags 7298 */ 7299 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7300 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7301 7302 /** 7303 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station 7304 * @dev: the netdev 7305 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7306 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics 7307 * @gfp: allocation flags 7308 */ 7309 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7310 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7311 7312 /** 7313 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station 7314 * 7315 * @dev: the netdev 7316 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7317 * @gfp: allocation flags 7318 */ 7319 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev, 7320 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp) 7321 { 7322 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp); 7323 } 7324 7325 /** 7326 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification 7327 * 7328 * @dev: the netdev 7329 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7330 * @reason: the reason for connection failure 7331 * @gfp: allocation flags 7332 * 7333 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station 7334 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection 7335 * for some reasons, this function is called. 7336 * 7337 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from 7338 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum 7339 */ 7340 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7341 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason, 7342 gfp_t gfp); 7343 7344 /** 7345 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 7346 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7347 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz 7348 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7349 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7350 * @len: length of the frame data 7351 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 7352 * 7353 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 7354 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 7355 * 7356 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 7357 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 7358 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 7359 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 7360 */ 7361 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, int sig_dbm, 7362 const u8 *buf, size_t len, u32 flags); 7363 7364 /** 7365 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 7366 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7367 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz 7368 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7369 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7370 * @len: length of the frame data 7371 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 7372 * 7373 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 7374 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 7375 * 7376 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 7377 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 7378 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 7379 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 7380 */ 7381 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, 7382 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 7383 u32 flags) 7384 { 7385 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(wdev, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), sig_dbm, buf, len, 7386 flags); 7387 } 7388 7389 /** 7390 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame 7391 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7392 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() 7393 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7394 * @len: length of the frame data 7395 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 7396 * @gfp: context flags 7397 * 7398 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be 7399 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the 7400 * transmission attempt. 7401 */ 7402 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7403 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp); 7404 7405 /** 7406 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control 7407 * port frames 7408 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7409 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() 7410 * @buf: Data frame (header + body) 7411 * @len: length of the frame data 7412 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 7413 * @gfp: context flags 7414 * 7415 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be 7416 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of 7417 * the transmission attempt. 7418 */ 7419 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7420 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, 7421 gfp_t gfp); 7422 7423 /** 7424 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame 7425 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7426 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf 7427 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear. 7428 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is 7429 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that 7430 * skb->protocol is set appropriately. 7431 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted 7432 * 7433 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port 7434 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive 7435 * control port frames over nl80211. 7436 * 7437 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all 7438 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame). 7439 * 7440 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace 7441 */ 7442 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, 7443 struct sk_buff *skb, bool unencrypted); 7444 7445 /** 7446 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event 7447 * @dev: network device 7448 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event 7449 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 7450 * @gfp: context flags 7451 * 7452 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring 7453 * rssi threshold reached event occurs. 7454 */ 7455 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7456 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 7457 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp); 7458 7459 /** 7460 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer 7461 * @dev: network device 7462 * @peer: peer's MAC address 7463 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold 7464 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent 7465 * threshold (to account for temporary interference) 7466 * @gfp: context flags 7467 */ 7468 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7469 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp); 7470 7471 /** 7472 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event 7473 * @dev: network device 7474 * @peer: peer's MAC address 7475 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost 7476 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission 7477 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached. 7478 * @gfp: context flags 7479 * 7480 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a 7481 * given interval is exceeded. 7482 */ 7483 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 7484 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp); 7485 7486 /** 7487 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event 7488 * @dev: network device 7489 * @gfp: context flags 7490 * 7491 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP. 7492 */ 7493 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp); 7494 7495 /** 7496 * cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event 7497 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7498 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 7499 * @gfp: context flags 7500 * 7501 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl. 7502 */ 7503 void cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7504 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, gfp_t gfp); 7505 7506 /** 7507 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event 7508 * @dev: network device 7509 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified 7510 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value 7511 * @gfp: context flags 7512 * 7513 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action 7514 * frame. 7515 */ 7516 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac, 7517 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode, 7518 gfp_t gfp); 7519 7520 /** 7521 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event 7522 * @netdev: network device 7523 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 7524 * @event: type of event 7525 * @gfp: context flags 7526 * 7527 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished 7528 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process, 7529 * also by full-MAC drivers. 7530 */ 7531 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev, 7532 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7533 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp); 7534 7535 7536 /** 7537 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying 7538 * @dev: network device 7539 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races) 7540 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter 7541 * @gfp: allocation flags 7542 */ 7543 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7544 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 7545 7546 /** 7547 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate 7548 * @dev: network device 7549 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority) 7550 * @bssid: BSSID of AP 7551 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication 7552 * @gfp: allocation flags 7553 */ 7554 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index, 7555 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp); 7556 7557 /** 7558 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame 7559 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7560 * @addr: the transmitter address 7561 * @gfp: context flags 7562 * 7563 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 7564 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the 7565 * sender. 7566 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 7567 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 7568 */ 7569 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev, 7570 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 7571 7572 /** 7573 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame 7574 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7575 * @addr: the transmitter address 7576 * @gfp: context flags 7577 * 7578 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 7579 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected. 7580 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each 7581 * station to avoid event flooding. 7582 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 7583 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 7584 */ 7585 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev, 7586 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 7587 7588 /** 7589 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status 7590 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on 7591 * @addr: the address of the peer 7592 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously 7593 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not 7594 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame. 7595 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not. 7596 * @gfp: allocation flags 7597 */ 7598 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 7599 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal, 7600 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp); 7601 7602 /** 7603 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs 7604 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 7605 * @frame: the frame 7606 * @len: length of the frame 7607 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz 7608 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7609 * 7610 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 7611 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 7612 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 7613 */ 7614 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame, 7615 size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm); 7616 7617 /** 7618 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs 7619 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 7620 * @frame: the frame 7621 * @len: length of the frame 7622 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on 7623 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7624 * 7625 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 7626 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 7627 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 7628 */ 7629 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7630 const u8 *frame, size_t len, 7631 int freq, int sig_dbm) 7632 { 7633 cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), 7634 sig_dbm); 7635 } 7636 7637 /** 7638 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed 7639 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7640 * @chandef: the channel definition 7641 * @iftype: interface type 7642 * 7643 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 7644 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.) 7645 */ 7646 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7647 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7648 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 7649 7650 /** 7651 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation 7652 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7653 * @chandef: the channel definition 7654 * @iftype: interface type 7655 * 7656 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 7657 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version 7658 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under 7659 * more permissive conditions. 7660 * 7661 * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held. 7662 */ 7663 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7664 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7665 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 7666 7667 /* 7668 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace 7669 * @dev: the device which switched channels 7670 * @chandef: the new channel definition 7671 * 7672 * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable 7673 * driver context! 7674 */ 7675 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7676 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 7677 7678 /* 7679 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start 7680 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started 7681 * @chandef: the future channel definition 7682 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens 7683 * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP 7684 * 7685 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just 7686 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting 7687 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary. 7688 */ 7689 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7690 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7691 u8 count, bool quiet); 7692 7693 /** 7694 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band 7695 * 7696 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert 7697 * @band: band pointer to fill 7698 * 7699 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 7700 */ 7701 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class, 7702 enum nl80211_band *band); 7703 7704 /** 7705 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class 7706 * 7707 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 7708 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class 7709 * 7710 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 7711 */ 7712 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7713 u8 *op_class); 7714 7715 /** 7716 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz 7717 * 7718 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 7719 * 7720 * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz. 7721 */ 7722 static inline u32 7723 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 7724 { 7725 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset; 7726 } 7727 7728 /* 7729 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation 7730 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested 7731 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device 7732 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or 7733 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN) 7734 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request 7735 * @gfp: allocation flags 7736 * 7737 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that 7738 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP 7739 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use 7740 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g., 7741 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer). 7742 */ 7743 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 7744 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 7745 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 7746 7747 /* 7748 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units) 7749 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from 7750 * 7751 * return 0 if MCS index >= 32 7752 */ 7753 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate); 7754 7755 /** 7756 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev 7757 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove 7758 * 7759 * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary 7760 * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device 7761 * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called 7762 * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device 7763 * is unbound from the driver. 7764 * 7765 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 7766 */ 7767 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 7768 7769 /** 7770 * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev 7771 * @dev: the netdev to register 7772 * 7773 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather 7774 * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is 7775 * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable 7776 * instead as well. 7777 * 7778 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 7779 */ 7780 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev); 7781 7782 /** 7783 * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev 7784 * @dev: the netdev to register 7785 * 7786 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather 7787 * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL 7788 * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are 7789 * usable instead as well. 7790 * 7791 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 7792 */ 7793 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev) 7794 { 7795 cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr); 7796 } 7797 7798 /** 7799 * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements 7800 * @ies: FT IEs 7801 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes 7802 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address 7803 * @ric_ies: RIC IE 7804 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes 7805 */ 7806 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params { 7807 const u8 *ies; 7808 size_t ies_len; 7809 const u8 *target_ap; 7810 const u8 *ric_ies; 7811 size_t ric_ies_len; 7812 }; 7813 7814 /** 7815 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE 7816 * @netdev: network device 7817 * @ft_event: IE information 7818 */ 7819 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev, 7820 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event); 7821 7822 /** 7823 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer 7824 * @ies: the input IE buffer 7825 * @len: the input length 7826 * @attr: the attribute ID to find 7827 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g. 7828 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size 7829 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer 7830 * 7831 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and 7832 * copies its contents to the given buffer. 7833 * 7834 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is 7835 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the 7836 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero). 7837 */ 7838 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 7839 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr, 7840 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize); 7841 7842 /** 7843 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC) 7844 * @ies: the IE buffer 7845 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 7846 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 7847 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 7848 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 7849 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 7850 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element 7851 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array 7852 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 7853 * 7854 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 7855 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 7856 * split. 7857 * 7858 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 7859 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 7860 * 7861 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 7862 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 7863 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 7864 * 7865 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 7866 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 7867 * of the buffer should be used. 7868 */ 7869 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 7870 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, 7871 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric, 7872 size_t offset); 7873 7874 /** 7875 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering 7876 * @ies: the IE buffer 7877 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 7878 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 7879 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 7880 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 7881 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 7882 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 7883 * 7884 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 7885 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 7886 * split. 7887 * 7888 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 7889 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 7890 * 7891 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 7892 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 7893 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 7894 * 7895 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 7896 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 7897 * of the buffer should be used. 7898 */ 7899 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 7900 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset) 7901 { 7902 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset); 7903 } 7904 7905 /** 7906 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN 7907 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup 7908 * @wakeup: the wakeup report 7909 * @gfp: allocation flags 7910 * 7911 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it 7912 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may 7913 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something 7914 * else caused the wakeup. 7915 */ 7916 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7917 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 7918 gfp_t gfp); 7919 7920 /** 7921 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver. 7922 * 7923 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped. 7924 * @gfp: allocation flags 7925 * 7926 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted 7927 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given 7928 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired. 7929 */ 7930 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp); 7931 7932 /** 7933 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has 7934 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7935 * 7936 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device. 7937 */ 7938 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7939 7940 /** 7941 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations 7942 * 7943 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7944 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 7945 * 7946 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a 7947 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to 7948 * the interface combinations. 7949 */ 7950 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7951 struct iface_combination_params *params); 7952 7953 /** 7954 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations 7955 * 7956 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7957 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 7958 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination 7959 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function 7960 * 7961 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible 7962 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching 7963 * purposes. 7964 */ 7965 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7966 struct iface_combination_params *params, 7967 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c, 7968 void *data), 7969 void *data); 7970 7971 /* 7972 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection 7973 * 7974 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7975 * @wdev: wireless device 7976 * @gfp: context flags 7977 * 7978 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA 7979 * disconnected. 7980 * 7981 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous. 7982 */ 7983 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7984 gfp_t gfp); 7985 7986 /** 7987 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy 7988 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down 7989 * 7990 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by 7991 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed). 7992 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors 7993 * that really can't be recovered in any other way. 7994 * 7995 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into 7996 * the driver while the function is running. 7997 */ 7998 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7999 8000 /** 8001 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag 8002 * 8003 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 8004 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 8005 * 8006 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 8007 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 8008 */ 8009 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8010 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 8011 { 8012 u8 *ft_byte; 8013 8014 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 8015 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8); 8016 } 8017 8018 /** 8019 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag 8020 * 8021 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 8022 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 8023 * 8024 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 8025 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 8026 */ 8027 static inline bool 8028 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8029 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 8030 { 8031 u8 ft_byte; 8032 8033 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 8034 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0; 8035 } 8036 8037 /** 8038 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function 8039 * @f: NAN function that should be freed 8040 * 8041 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members. 8042 */ 8043 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f); 8044 8045 /** 8046 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters 8047 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is 8048 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber. 8049 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery 8050 * result. 8051 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up. 8052 * @inst_id: the local instance id 8053 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function 8054 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer 8055 * @info_len: the length of the &info 8056 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any) 8057 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function 8058 */ 8059 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params { 8060 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 8061 u8 inst_id; 8062 u8 peer_inst_id; 8063 const u8 *addr; 8064 u8 info_len; 8065 const u8 *info; 8066 u64 cookie; 8067 }; 8068 8069 /** 8070 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function. 8071 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 8072 * @match: match notification parameters 8073 * @gfp: allocation flags 8074 * 8075 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This 8076 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that 8077 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received. 8078 */ 8079 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8080 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp); 8081 8082 /** 8083 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 8084 * 8085 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 8086 * @inst_id: the local instance id 8087 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 8088 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier 8089 * @gfp: allocation flags 8090 * 8091 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated. 8092 */ 8093 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8094 u8 inst_id, 8095 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 8096 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp); 8097 8098 /* ethtool helper */ 8099 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info); 8100 8101 /** 8102 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication 8103 * @netdev: network device 8104 * @params: External authentication parameters 8105 * @gfp: allocation flags 8106 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error 8107 */ 8108 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev, 8109 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params, 8110 gfp_t gfp); 8111 8112 /** 8113 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data 8114 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 8115 * @req: the original measurement request 8116 * @result: the result data 8117 * @gfp: allocation flags 8118 */ 8119 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8120 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 8121 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result, 8122 gfp_t gfp); 8123 8124 /** 8125 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed 8126 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 8127 * @req: the original measurement request 8128 * @gfp: allocation flags 8129 * 8130 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this 8131 * the request pointer will no longer be valid. 8132 */ 8133 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8134 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 8135 gfp_t gfp); 8136 8137 /** 8138 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed 8139 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8140 * @iftype: interface type 8141 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1' 8142 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces 8143 * 8144 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API 8145 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when 8146 * check_swif is '1'. 8147 */ 8148 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 8149 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif); 8150 8151 8152 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */ 8153 8154 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */ 8155 8156 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \ 8157 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8158 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8159 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8160 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8161 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8162 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8163 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8164 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8165 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8166 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8167 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8168 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8169 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8170 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8171 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8172 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8173 dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8174 8175 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8176 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8177 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8178 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8179 8180 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8181 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args) 8182 8183 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8184 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8185 8186 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG) 8187 #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg 8188 #else 8189 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8190 ({ \ 8191 if (0) \ 8192 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \ 8193 0; \ 8194 }) 8195 #endif 8196 8197 /* 8198 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference 8199 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the 8200 * file/line information and a backtrace. 8201 */ 8202 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8203 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args); 8204 8205 /** 8206 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space 8207 * @netdev: network device 8208 * @owe_info: peer's owe info 8209 * @gfp: allocation flags 8210 */ 8211 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev, 8212 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info, 8213 gfp_t gfp); 8214 8215 /** 8216 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries 8217 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8218 */ 8219 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy); 8220 8221 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */ 8222